Ec PDF
Ec PDF
Ec PDF
B ENGINE
E
CONTENTS
VQ35DE TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ............................................ 77 F
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction ............................... 77
INDEX FOR DTC ...................................................... 15 DTC Inspection Priority Chart ................................. 80
Alphabetical Index .................................................. 15 Fail-Safe Chart ....................................................... 82 G
DTC No. Index ....................................................... 19 Basic Inspection ..................................................... 83
PRECAUTIONS ........................................................ 23 Symptom Matrix Chart ............................................ 88
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System Engine Control Component Parts Location ............ 92
(SRS) “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TEN- H
Circuit Diagram ....................................................... 98
SIONER” ................................................................ 23 ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout ........... 100
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine and ECM Terminals and Reference Value ................... 100
A/T .......................................................................... 23 CONSULT-II Function ........................................... 109 I
Precaution .............................................................. 23 Generic Scan Tool (GST) Function ....................... 122
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis ................ 26 CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor ..... 125
PREPARATION ......................................................... 27 Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor J
Special Service Tools ............................................. 27 Mode ..................................................................... 129
Commercial Service Tools ...................................... 28 TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE. 131
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM .................................. 29 Description ............................................................ 131
System Diagram ..................................................... 29 K
Testing Condition .................................................. 131
Vacuum Hose Drawing ........................................... 30 Inspection Procedure ............................................ 131
System Chart ......................................................... 31 Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 132
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System .................... 32 TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI- L
Electronic Ignition (EI) System ............................... 34 DENT ....................................................................... 135
Air Conditioning Cut Control ................................... 35 Description ............................................................ 135
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 135 M
Speed) .................................................................... 35 POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT ........... 136
CAN communication .............................................. 36 Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 136
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE .............................. 37 Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 137
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check .................... 37 Ground Inspection ................................................ 141
Idle Speed/Ignition Timing/Idle Mixture Ratio DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE. 142
Adjustment ............................................................. 38 Description ............................................................ 142
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ...... 49 On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 142
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning ................ 49 DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 142
Idle Air Volume Learning ........................................ 49 Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 143
Fuel Pressure Check .............................................. 51 Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 144
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ............ 53 DTC P0011, P0021 IVT CONTROL ........................ 145
Introduction ............................................................ 53 Description ............................................................ 145
Two Trip Detection Logic ........................................ 53 CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode
Emission-Related Diagnostic Information .............. 54 . 145
IVIS (Infiniti Vehicle Immobilizer System — NATS)... 68 On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 146
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ........................... 68
OBD System Operation Chart ................................ 72
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000, EC
U1001. Refer to EC-142, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
×:Applicable —: Not applicable
1
DTC* C
Items MIL lighting
CONSULT-II Trip Reference page
(CONSULT-II screen terms) up
ECM*3
GST*2
A/T INTERLOCK P1730 1730 1 × AT-147 D
A/T TCC S/V FNCTN P0744 0744 2 × AT-125
A
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-142, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
×:Applicable —: Not applicable EC
DTC*1
Items MIL lighting
CONSULT-II Trip Reference page
(CONSULT-II screen terms) up C
ECM*3
GST*2
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
No DTC Flashing*4 FURTHER TESTING — Flashing*4 EC-69
MAY BE REQUIRED. D
The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along EC
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. This system includes seat belt switch inputs and dual stage front air bag modules. The SRS
system uses the seat belt switches to determine the front air bag deployment, and may only deploy one front C
air bag, depending on the severity of a collision and whether the front occupants are belted or unbelted.
Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of this Service Man-
ual.
WARNING: D
● To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer. E
● Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section. F
● Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or
harness connectors.
G
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine and A/T ABS006JZ
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) to warn the
driver of a malfunction causing emission deterioration. H
CAUTION:
● Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the negative battery cable before any
repair or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves, I
etc. will cause the MIL to light up.
● Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
cause the MIL to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease, J
dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
● Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-
locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG-74, "HAR- K
NESS CONNECTOR" .
● Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness
with a bracket, etc. may cause the MIL to light up due to the short circuit. L
● Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
may cause the MIL to light up due to the malfunction of the EVAP system or fuel injection system,
etc.
M
● Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM and
TCM (Transmission control module) before returning the vehicle to the customer.
Precaution ABS006K0
PBIB1164E
PBIB1512E
SEF217U
D
● When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never
allow the two tester probes to contact.
Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and E
damage the ECM power transistor.
● Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/
output voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's F
transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as
the ground.
G
SEF348N
K
SEC893C
PBIB1569E
SEF709Y
The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.
Tool number EC
(Kent-Moore No.) Description
Tool name
S-NT564
S-NT379
G
KV10114400 Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
(J-38365) a: 22 mm (0.87 in)
Heated oxygen
H
sensor wrench
I
S-NT636
K
LEC642
S-NT825
S-NT826
Tool name
Description
(Kent-Moore No.)
S-NT703
S-NT704
Fuel filler cap adapter Checking fuel tank vacuum relief valve opening
i.e.: (MLR-8382) pressure
S-NT815
S-NT705
S-NT779
EC
PBIB2294E
PBIB2000E
A
Input (Sensor) ECM Function Output (Actuator)
● Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Fuel injection & mixture ratio control Fuel injector
● Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Electronic ignition system Power transistor EC
● Mass air flow sensor Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
● Engine coolant temperature sensor
ICC vehicle speed control Electric throttle control actuator
● Heated oxygen sensor 1 C
ASCD vehicle speed control Electric throttle control actuator
● Throttle position sensor
On board diagnostic system MIL (On the instrument panel)*4
● Accelerator pedal position sensor
● Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater D
● Intake air temperature sensor Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
● Power steering pressure sensor EVAP canister purge volume control
EVAP canister purge flow control E
● Ignition switch solenoid valve
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined
by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from both the crankshaft position sensor and the mass air
flow sensor.
VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION
In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operat-
ing conditions as listed below.
<Fuel increase>
● During warm-up
● When starting the engine
● During acceleration
● Hot-engine operation
● When selector lever is changed from N to D
● High-load, high-speed operation
<Fuel decrease>
● During deceleration
● During high engine speed operation
EC
PBIB0121E D
The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for driveability and emission control.
The three way catalyst 1 can then better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor whether the engine operation is rich or lean. The ECM adjusts E
the injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about heated oxygen
sensor 1, refer to EC-205 . This maintains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric (ideal air-fuel
mixture).
This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition. F
Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst 1. Even if the switching characteris-
tics of heated oxygen sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal from heated
oxygen sensor 2. G
Open Loop Control
The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion. H
● Deceleration and acceleration
● High-load, high-speed operation
● Malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1 or its circuit I
● Insufficient activation of heated oxygen sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
● High engine coolant temperature
J
● During warm-up
● After shifting from N to D
● When starting the engine K
MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from heated oxygen
sensor 1. This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to L
the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as orig-
inally designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot wire) and characteristic
changes during operation (i.e., injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio. M
Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
then computed in terms of “injection pulse duration” to automatically compensate for the difference between
the two ratios.
“Fuel trim” refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
includes short term fuel trim and long term fuel trim.
“Short term fuel trim” is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
value. The signal from heated oxygen sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an
increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
“Long term fuel trim” is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short term fuel trim from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences,
wear over time and changes in the usage environment.
SEF179U
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-
fuel ratio for every running condition of the engine. The ignition tim-
ing data is stored in the ECM. This data forms the map shown.
The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and
camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition
signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
e.g., N: 1,800 rpm, Tp: 1.50 msec
A °BTDC
During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the
ECM according to the other data stored in the ECM.
● At starting SEF742M
● During warm-up
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION I
This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used.
Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
● When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed. J
● When cranking the engine.
● At high engine speeds.
● When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high. K
● When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed.
● When engine speed is excessively low.
L
● When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Speed) ABS006KA
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
If the engine speed is above 1,800 rpm under no load (for example, the shift position is neutral and engine
speed is over 1,800 rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies
based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will be operated until the engine speed reaches 1,500 rpm, then fuel cut will be cancelled.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
Refer to LAN-6, "CAN Communication Unit" , about CAN communication for detail.
IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II EC
Check idle speed in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
E
SEF058Y
With GST
Check idle speed with GST. F
IGNITION TIMING
Any of following two methods may be used. G
Method A
1. Attach timing light to loop wire as shown.
H
PBIB1574E
K
2. Check ignition timing.
PBIB1602E
Method B
1. Remove No. 1 ignition coil.
PBIB1567E
PBIB1573E
SEF166Y
PBIB1602E
PREPARATION
1. Make sure that the following parts are in good order.
● Battery
● Ignition system
● Fuses
● Vacuum hoses
● Engine compression
● Throttle valve
2. On air conditioner equipped models, checks should be carried out while the air conditioner is OFF.
3. On automatic transmission equipped models, when checking idle rpm, ignition timing and mixture ratio,
checks should be carried out while shift lever is in N position.
4. When measuring CO percentage, insert probe more than 40 cm (15.7 in) into tail pipe.
5. Turn OFF headlamp, heater blower, rear window defogger.
EC
PBIB2001E
SEF976U
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
SEF977U
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3.
E
PBIA8513J
SEF058Y
I
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-load, then run engine at idle speed for about J
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
K
650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10. L
NG >> GO TO 4.
>> GO TO 5.
>> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 8.
>> GO TO 4.
PBIB1602E
E
11. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
F
2. Perform EC-49, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 12. G
>> GO TO 13.
I
13. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" . J
Is Idle Air Volume Learning carried out successfully?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 14. K
No >> 1. Follow the instruction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
L
14. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. M
2. Read idle speed in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15. SEF174Y
NG >> GO TO 17.
PBIB1602E
>> GO TO 4.
F
20. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 (BANK 1) SIGNAL
Without CONSULT-II
G
1. Stop engine and set ECM to Self-diagnostic mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor). Refer to EC-70,
"HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
2. Start engine and run it at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
H
3. Running engine at 2,000 rpm under no-load (The engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature.),
check that the MIL comes on more than 5 times during 10 seconds.
OK or NG
I
OK >> GO TO 22.
NG (MIL does not come on)>>GO TO 23.
NG (MIL comes on less than 5 times)>>GO TO 31.
J
21. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 (BANK 2) SIGNAL
With CONSULT-II K
1. See “HO2S1 MNTR (B2)” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
2. Running engine at 2,000 rpm under no-load (The engine is
warmed up to normal operating temperature.), check that the L
monitor fluctuates between LEAN and RICH more than 5 times
during 10 seconds.
1 time: RICH → LEAN → RICH M
2 times: RICH → LEAN → RICH → LEAN → RICH
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG (Monitor does not fluctuate.)>>GO TO 24.
NG (Monitor fluctuates less than 5 times.)>>GO TO 31. PBIB0120E
>> GO TO 26.
>> GO TO 27.
sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 31.
NG >> GO TO 30.
>> GO TO 34.
Revision: 2004 November EC-47 2004 FX35/FX45
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
[VQ35DE]
31. REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
1. Stop engine.
2. Replace heated oxygen sensor 1 on the malfunctioning bank.
>> GO TO 4.
C
36. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.) D
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to BL-
208, "ECM Re-communicating Function" .
E
>> GO TO 4.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ABS006KE F
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time G
harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released. H
2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds. I
5. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning ABS006KF J
DESCRIPTION
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully closed position of the throttle valve by
monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of K
electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released. L
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Make sure that throttle valve moves during above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound. M
Idle Air Volume Learning ABS006KG
DESCRIPTION
Idle Air Volume Learning is an operation to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine within the specific
range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
● Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
● Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
PREPARATION
Before performing Idle Air Volume Learning, make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
● Battery voltage: More than 12.9V (At idle)
● Engine coolant temperature: 70 - 100°C (158 - 212°F)
● PNP switch: ON
● Electric load switch: OFF
(Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
SEF217Z
SEF454Y
Without CONSULT-II
NOTE:
● It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
● It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
1. Perform EC-49, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
H
SEC897C
12. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the
specifications. I
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed 650±50 rpm (in P or N position) J
Ignition timing 15±5° BTDC (in P or N position)
13. If idle speed and ignition timing are not within the specification, Idle Air Volume Learning will not be carried
out successfully. In this case, find the cause of the incident by referring to the DIAGNOSTIC PROCE- K
DURE below.
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
L
If idle air volume learning cannot be performed successfully, proceed as follows:
1. Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
2. Check PCV valve operation.
M
3. Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
4. When the above three items check out OK, engine component parts and their installation condi-
tion are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of the incident.
It is useful to perform EC-131, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
5. If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the
incident and perform Idle air volume learning all over again:
● Engine stalls.
● Erroneous idle.
SEF214Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in IPDM E/R.
2. Start engine.
3. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF.
5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
PBIB1603E
● Fuel pump
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system, which detects malfunctions related to engine sensors or actua-
tors. The ECM also records various emission-related diagnostic information including: EC
Emission-related diagnostic information SAE Mode
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Mode 3 of SAE J1979
Freeze Frame data Mode 2 of SAE J1979
C
The above information can be checked using procedures listed in the table below.
×: Applicable —: Not applicable
F
Freeze Frame 1st trip Freeze
DTC 1st trip DTC SRT code Test value
data Frame data
CONSULT-II × × × × × —
G
GST × × × — × ×
ECM × ×* — — — —
*: When DTC and 1st trip DTC simultaneously appear on the display, they cannot be clearly distinguished from each other. H
The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel lights up when the same malfunction is detected
in two consecutive trips (Two trip detection logic), or when the ECM enters fail-safe mode. (Refer to EC-82 .)
I
Two Trip Detection Logic ABS006KJ
When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
ECM memory. The MIL will not light up at this stage. <1st trip> J
If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
the ECM memory, and the MIL lights up. The MIL lights up at the same time when the DTC is stored. <2nd
trip> The “trip” in the “Two Trip Detection Logic” means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed K
during vehicle operation. Specific on board diagnostic items will cause the ECM to light up or blink the MIL,
and store DTC and Freeze Frame data, even in the 1st trip, as shown below.
×: Applicable —: Not applicable
L
MIL DTC 1st trip DTC
1st trip 2nd trip 2nd trip
Items 1st trip 2nd trip 1st trip
Lighting Lighting display-
Blinking Blinking displaying displaying displaying M
up up ing
When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the driver by lighting MIL up when there is
malfunction on engine control system.
Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related diagnoses are continuously detected as
NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open by means
of operating fail-safe function.
PBIB0911E
For example, the EGR malfunction (Priority: 2) was detected and the freeze frame data was stored in the 2nd
trip. After that when the misfire (Priority: 1) is detected in another trip, the freeze frame data will be updated C
from the EGR malfunction to the misfire. The 1st trip freeze frame data is updated each time a different mal-
function is detected. There is no priority for 1st trip freeze frame data. However, once freeze frame data is
stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze data is no longer stored (because only one freeze frame data or 1st D
trip freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM). If freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory and freeze
frame data with the same priority occurs later, the first (original) freeze frame data remains unchanged in the
ECM memory.
Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM mem- E
ory is erased. Procedures for clearing the ECM memory are described in EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE EMIS-
SION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
SYSTEM READINESS TEST (SRT) CODE F
System Readiness Test (SRT) code is specified in Mode 1 of SAE J1979.
As part of an enhanced emissions test for Inspection & Maintenance (I/M), certain states require the status of
SRT be used to indicate whether the ECM has completed self-diagnosis of major emission systems and com- G
ponents. Completion must be verified in order for the emissions inspection to proceed.
If a vehicle is rejected for a State emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating “INCMP”, use
the information in this Service Manual to set the SRT to “CMPLT”. H
In most cases the ECM will automatically complete its self-diagnosis cycle during normal usage, and the SRT
status will indicate “CMPLT” for each application system. Once set as “CMPLT”, the SRT status remains
“CMPLT” until the self-diagnosis memory is erased.
Occasionally, certain portions of the self-diagnostic test may not be completed as a result of the customer's I
normal driving pattern; the SRT will indicate “INCMP” for these items.
NOTE:
The SRT will also indicate “INCMP” if the self-diagnosis memory is erased for any reason or if the ECM mem- J
ory power supply is interrupted for several hours.
If, during the state emissions inspection, the SRT indicates “CMPLT” for all test items, the inspector will con-
tinue with the emissions test. However, if the SRT indicates “INCMP” for one or more of the SRT items the K
vehicle is returned to the customer untested.
NOTE:
If MIL is ON during the state emissions inspection, the vehicle is also returned to the customer untested even
though the SRT indicates “CMPLT” for all test items. Therefore, it is important to check SRT (“CMPLT”) and L
DTC (No DTCs) before the inspection.
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results in a single cycle (Ignition OFF-ON-OFF), the SRT will
indicate “CMPLT”. → Case 1 above
SEF573XA
PBIB1053E
SEF414S
SCIA5334E
With GST
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting MODE 4 with GST.
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for A/T related items (see EC-15 ), skip step 2.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least 10
seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
DESCRIPTION
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MIL will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON with-
out the engine running. This is a bulb check.
If the MIL does not light up, refer to DI-39, "WARNING LAMPS" ,
or see EC-641 .
2. When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the MIL remains on, the on board diagnostic system has
detected an engine system malfunction.
SEF217U
Engine stopped
Engine stopped
I
Engine running HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 This function allows the fuel mixture condition (lean or J
MONITOR rich), monitored by heated oxygen sensor 1, to be read.
K
When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the driver by lighting MIL up when there is
malfunction on engine control system.
Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related diagnoses are continuously detected as L
NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open by means
of operating fail-safe function.
The fail-safe function also operates when above diagnoses except MIL circuit are detected and demands the
driver to repair the malfunction. M
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode Engine speed will not rise more than 2,500 rpm due to the fuel cut
PBIB0092E
PBIB0093E
PBIA3905E L
A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes. The “zero” is indicated
by the number of ten flashes. The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds
consisting of an ON (0.6-second) - OFF (0.6-second) cycle.
M
The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-second ON and 0.3-second OFF cycle.
A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-second OFF.
In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no mal-
function. (See EC-15, "INDEX FOR DTC" )
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-Diagnostic Results)
The DTC can be erased from the back up memory in the ECM by depressing accelerator pedal. Refer to EC-
70, "How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-Diagnostic Results)" .
● If the battery is disconnected, the DTC will be lost from the backup memory within 24 hours.
● Be careful not to erase the stored memory before starting trouble diagnoses.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II — HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 MONITOR
In this mode, the MIL displays the condition of the fuel mixture (lean or rich) which is monitored by the heated
oxygen sensor 1.
To check the heated oxygen sensor 1 function, start engine in the Diagnostic Test Mode II and warm it up until
engine coolant temperature indicator points to the middle of the gauge.
Next run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load conditions. Then make sure that the
MIL comes ON more than 5 times within 10 seconds with engine running at 2,000 rpm under no-load.
OBD System Operation Chart ABS006KN
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MIL, 1ST TRIP DTC, DTC, AND DETECTABLE ITEMS
● When a malfunction is detected for the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory.
● When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, the DTC and the freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory, and the MIL will come on. For details, refer to EC-53, "Two Trip Detection
Logic" .
● The MIL will go off after the vehicle is driven 3 times with no malfunction. The drive is counted only when
the recorded driving pattern is met (as stored in the ECM). If another malfunction occurs while counting,
the counter will reset.
● The DTC and the freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 40 times (driving pattern A)
without the same malfunction recurring (except for Misfire and Fuel Injection System). For Misfire and
Fuel Injection System, the DTC and freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 80 times
(driving pattern C) without the same malfunction recurring. The “TIME” in “SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS” mode of CONSULT-II will count the number of times the vehicle is driven.
● The 1st trip DTC is not displayed when the self-diagnosis results in OK for the 2nd trip.
SUMMARY CHART
Items Fuel Injection System Misfire Other
MIL (goes off) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B)
DTC, Freeze Frame Data (no
80 (pattern C) 80 (pattern C) 40 (pattern A)
display)
1st Trip DTC (clear) 1 (pattern C), *1 1 (pattern C), *1 1 (pattern B)
1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
*1, *2 *1, *2 1 (pattern B)
(clear)
For details about patterns B and C under “Fuel Injection System” and “Misfire”, see EC-74 .
For details about patterns A and B under Other, see EC-76 .
*1: Clear timing is at the moment OK is detected.
*2: Clear timing is when the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip.
EC
SEF392S
*1: When the same malfunction is *2: MIL will go off after vehicle is driven *3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, 3 times (pattern B) without any mal- detected in two consecutive trips, the
MIL will light up. functions. DTC and the freeze frame data will
be stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data *5: When a malfunction is detected for *6: The 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip
will not be displayed any longer after the first time, the 1st trip DTC and freeze frame data will be cleared at
vehicle is driven 80 times (pattern C) the 1st trip freeze frame data will be the moment OK is detected.
without the same malfunction. (The stored in ECM.
DTC and the freeze frame data still
remain in ECM.)
*7: When the same malfunction is *8: 1st trip DTC will be cleared when
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip vehicle is driven once (pattern C)
freeze frame data will be cleared. without the same malfunction after
DTC is stored in ECM.
EC
SEF393SD
*1: When the same malfunction is *2: MIL will go off after vehicle is driven *3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, 3 times (pattern B) without any mal- detected in two consecutive trips, the
MIL will light up. functions. DTC and the freeze frame data will
be stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data *5: When a malfunction is detected for *6: 1st trip DTC will be cleared after
will not be displayed any longer after the first time, the 1st trip DTC and vehicle is driven once (pattern B)
vehicle is driven 40 times (pattern A) the 1st trip freeze frame data will be without the same malfunction.
without the same malfunction. stored in ECM.
(The DTC and the freeze frame data
still remain in ECM.)
*7: When the same malfunction is
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared.
AEC574
● The A counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected regardless of (1) - (4).
● The A counter will be counted up when (1) - (4) are satisfied without the same malfunction.
● The DTC will not be displayed after the A counter reaches 40.
<Driving Pattern B>
Driving pattern B means the vehicle operation as follows:
All components and systems should be monitored at least once by the OBD system.
● The B counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected once regardless of the driving pattern.
● The B counter will be counted up when driving pattern B is satisfied without any malfunctions.
● The MIL will go off when the B counter reaches 3 (*2 in OBD SYSTEM OPERATION CHART).
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel con- EC
trol, ignition control, idle air control system, etc. The ECM accepts
input signals from sensors and instantly drives actuators. It is essen-
tial that both input and output signals are proper and stable. At the
same time, it is important that there are no malfunctions such as vac- C
uum leaks, fouled spark plugs, or other malfunctions with the engine.
MEF036D
E
SEF233G
I
A visual check only may not find the cause of the incidents. A road
test with CONSULT-II (or GST) or a circuit tester connected should
be performed. Follow the Work Flow on EC-78 . J
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such incidents, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under K
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the example
on EC-80 should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional malfunctions first. L
This will help troubleshoot driveability malfunctions on an electroni-
SEF234G
cally controlled engine vehicle.
M
PBIB1043E
*1 If time data of “SELF-DIAG *2 If the incident cannot be verified, per- *3 If the on board diagnostic system
RESULTS” is other than “0” or “[1t]”, form EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNO- cannot be performed, check main
perform EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAG- SIS FOR INTERMITTENT power supply and ground circuit.
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI- INCIDENT" . Refer to EC-136, "POWER SUPPLY
DENT" . AND GROUND CIRCUIT" .
*4 If malfunctioning part cannot be *5 EC-64 *6 EC-131
detected, perform EC-135, "TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMIT-
TENT INCIDENT" .
Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident/symptom occurred using the
STEP I
“DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET”, EC-79 .
EC
Before confirming the concern, check and write down (print out using CONSULT-II or GST) the (1st trip) DTC and the
(1st trip) freeze frame data, then erase the DTC and the data. (Refer to EC-67 .) The (1st trip) DTC and the (1st trip)
freeze frame data can be used when duplicating the incident at STEP III & IV.
STEP II If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" . C
Study the relationship between the cause, specified by (1st trip) DTC, and the symptom described by the customer.
(The Symptom Matrix Chart will be useful. See EC-88 .)
Also check related service bulletins for information.
D
Try to confirm the symptom and under what conditions the incident occurs.
The DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET and the freeze frame data are useful to verify the incident. Connect CONSULT-II
STEP III to the vehicle in “DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG)” mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" . E
If the malfunction code is detected, skip STEP IV and perform STEP V.
Try to detect the (1st trip) DTC by driving in (or performing) the DTC Confirmation Procedure. Check and read the (1st
trip) DTC and (1st trip) freeze frame data by using CONSULT-II or GST.
During the (1st trip) DTC verification, be sure to connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in“ DATA MONITOR (AUTO F
TRIG)” mode and check real time diagnosis results.
STEP IV
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
In case the DTC Confirmation Procedure is not available, perform the Overall Function Check instead. The (1st trip)
G
DTC cannot be displayed by this check, however, this simplified check is an effective alternative.
The NG result of the Overall Function Check is the same as the (1st trip) DTC detection.
Take the appropriate action based on the results of STEP I through IV.
If the malfunction code is indicated, proceed to TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR DTC PXXXX. H
STEP V
If the normal code is indicated, proceed to the BASIC INSPECTION. (Refer to EC-83 .) Then perform inspections
according to the Symptom Matrix Chart. (Refer to EC-88 .)
Identify where to begin diagnosis based on the relationship study between symptom and possible causes. Inspect the I
system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage using (tracing) Harness Layouts.
Gently shake the related connectors, components or wiring harness with CONSULT-II set in “DATA MONITOR
(AUTO TRIG)” mode.
Check the voltage of the related ECM terminals or monitor the output data from the related sensors with CONSULT-II. J
Refer to EC-100 , EC-125 .
STEP VI
The Diagnostic Procedure in EC section contains a description based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit
inspection is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure. For details, refer to Circuit Inspection in
GI-27, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .
K
Repair or replace the malfunction parts.
If malfunctioning part cannot be detected, perform EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" . L
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component, you need to run the engine in the same conditions and
circumstances which resulted in the customer's initial complaint.
Perform the DTC Confirmation Procedure and confirm the normal code [DTC No. P0000] is detected. If the incident is
STEP VII still detected in the final check, perform STEP VI by using a method different from the previous one. M
Before returning the vehicle to the customer, be sure to erase the unnecessary (already fixed) (1st trip) DTC in ECM
and TCM (Transmission control module). (Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC
INFORMATION" and AT-39, "HOW TO ERASE DTC" .)
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
Description
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about a incident. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one on the next page in order
to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
Some conditions may cause the MIL to come on steady or blink and
DTC to be detected. Examples:
● Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire. SEF907L
MTBL0017
If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
chart.
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 and/or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
When the DTC listed below is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
P0102 Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
P0103
P0117 Engine coolant tempera- Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning
P0118 ture sensor circuit ignition switch ON or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Engine coolant temperature decided
Condition
(CONSULT-II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned
40°C (104°F)
ON or START
More than approx. 4 minutes after
80°C (176°F)
ignition ON or START
40 - 80°C (104 - 176°F)
Except as shown above
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling
fan operates while engine is running.
P0122 Throttle position sensor The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in
P0123 order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
P0222 The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal
P0223 condition.
P2135 So, the acceleration will be poor.
P1121 Electric throttle control (When electric throttle control actuator does not function properly due to the return spring
actuator malfunction:)
ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the
idle position. The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
(When throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is not in specified range:)
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20
degrees or less.
(When ECM detects the throttle valve is stuck open:)
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops,
the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or
more.
P1122 Electric throttle control ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
function fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1124 Throttle control motor relay ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
P1126 fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1128 Throttle control motor ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1229 Sensor power supply ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P2122 Accelerator pedal position The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in
P2123 sensor order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
P2127 The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal
P2128 condition.
P2138 So, the acceleration will be poor.
● When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the driver by lighting MIL up when
there is malfunction on engine control system.
Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related diagnoses are continuously detected
as NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open by
means of operating fail-safe function.
The fail-safe function also operates when above diagnoses except MIL circuit are detected and demands
the driver to repair the malfunction.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode Engine speed will not rise more than 2,500 rpm due to the fuel cut
1. INSPECTION START A
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related malfunction, or a current need for
scheduled maintenance. EC
2. Open engine hood and check the following:
– Harness connectors for improper connections
– Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut C
– Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
– Hoses and ducts for leaks
D
– Air cleaner clogging
– Gasket
3. Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied. E
– Headlamp switch is OFF. SEF983U
SEF976U
J
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or GST. K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2. L
M
SEF977U
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3.
PBIA8513J
SEF058Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 4.
>> GO TO 5.
>> GO TO 6.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10. SEF174Y H
NG >> GO TO 8.
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.)
M
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-
68, "IVIS (Infiniti Vehicle Immobilizer System — NATS)" .
>> GO TO 4.
PBIB1602E
>> GO TO 12.
>> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 17.
PBIB1602E
E
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-63, "TIMING CHAIN" .
F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation. G
2. GO TO 4.
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.) L
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-
68, "IVIS (Infiniti Vehicle Immobilizer System — NATS)" .
M
>> GO TO 4.
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
ENGINE STALL
HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
D
ENGINE STALL E
K
LACK OF POWER/POOR ACCELERATION
HARD/NO START/RESTART (EXCP. HA)
L
EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION
SPARK KNOCK/DETONATION
Reference
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
M
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
ENGINE STALL
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
ENGINE STALL
HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
D
ENGINE STALL E
PBIB2002E
EC
PBIB2003E
PBIB1616E
EC
F
PBIB1189E
PBIB1617E
PBIB2004E
EC
PBIB1619E
TBWH0101E
EC
TBWM0522E
PBIB1192E
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the passenger side instrument lower
panel. For this inspection, remove passenger side instrument
lower panel.
2. Remove ECM harness connector.
PBIB1578E
PBIB1512E
Approximately 8V
EC
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1 C
2 L ● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm
heater (bank 2)
PBIB0519E
D
[Engine is running] BATTERY VOLTAGE
● Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (11 - 14V)
0 - 14V
PBIB1104E
0 - 14V H
[Ignition switch: ON]
Throttle control motor ● Engine stopped
5 L/B I
(Open) ● Shift lever: D
● Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed
PBIB1105E J
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm after the
following conditions are met K
– Engine: after warming up 0 - 1.0V
– Keeping the engine speed between 3,500
Heated oxygen sensor 2 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle for 1 L
6 R
heater (bank 2) minute under no load
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped BATTERY VOLTAGE M
[Engine is running] (11 - 14V)
● Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
[Engine is running]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● Warm-up condition
(11 - 14V)
● Idle speed
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
10 OR [Engine is running]
solenoid valve (bank 2)
● Warm-up condition
● When revving engine up to 2,500 rpm
quickly
PBIB1790E
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
11 BR [Engine is running]
solenoid valve (bank 1)
● Warm-up condition
● When revving engine up to 2,500 rpm
quickly
PBIB1790E
[Engine is running]
0.5 - 4.5V
Power steering pressure ● Steering wheel is being turned
12 R/G
sensor [Engine is running]
0.4 - 0.8V
● Steering wheel is not being turned
Approximately 1.6V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
Crankshaft position sensor PBIB1041E
13 Y
(POS)
Approximately 1.4V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1042E
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1039E
Camshaft position sensor
14 BR
(PHASE) (bank 2)
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1040E
[Engine is running]
15 W Knock sensor Approximately 2.5V
● Idle speed
[Engine is running]
Heated oxygen sensor 1 0 - Approximately 1.0V
16 R/L ● Warm-up condition
(bank 2) (Periodically change)
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
SEC985C
G
Approximately 8V
[Engine is running]
H
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
24 L ● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm
heater (bank 1)
I
PBIB0519E
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1039E
Camshaft position sensor
33 R/L
(PHASE) (bank 1)
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1040E
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Intake air temperature sen-
34 OR [Engine is running] Output voltage varies with intake
sor
air temperature.
[Engine is running]
Heated oxygen sensor 1 0 - Approximately 1.0V
35 BR ● Warm-up condition
(bank 1) (Periodically change)
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Engine is running] (11 - 14V)
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
40 LG Injector No. 6 SEC984C
41 B Injector No. 4
42 P Injector No. 2 BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
SEC985C
[Engine is running]
● Idle speed C
SEC991C
0 - 0.2V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
60 PU Ignition signal No. 5 SEC986C
61 L Ignition signal No. 3
62 Y Ignition signal No. 1 0.1 - 0.4V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
SEC987C
[Engine is running]
Sensor ground
66 B ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V
(Throttle position sensor)
● Idle speed
[Engine is running]
67 B/W Sensor ground ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V
● Idle speed
Sensor power supply
68 BR (Power steering pressure [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 5V
sensor)
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped
Less than 4.75V
● Shift lever: D
● Accelerator pedal: Fully released
69 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped
More than 0.36V
● Shift lever: D
● Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
70 L/R Refrigerant pressure sensor 1.0 - 4.0V
● Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON
(Compressor operates)
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Engine coolant temperature
73 Y [Engine is running] Output voltage varies with
sensor
engine coolant temperature.
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm
Heated oxygen sensor 2
74 LG/B quickly after the following conditions are met 0 - Approximately 1.0V
(bank 1)
– After keeping the engine speed between
3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle
for 1 minute under no load
[Engine is running]
Sensor ground
78 B/R ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V
(Heated oxygen sensor)
● Idle speed
0 - 0.2V
[Engine is running] EC
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE: C
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
79 SB Ignition signal No. 6 SEC986C
80 GY Ignition signal No. 4 D
81 OR Ignition signal No. 2 0.1 - 0.4V
[Engine is running]
E
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
F
SEC987C
[Engine is running]
Sensor ground
Warm-up condition
H
83 G/OR ● Approximately 0V
(APP sensor 2)
● Idle speed
[Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 5V - Battery volt-
85 PU Data link connector I
● CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected age (11 - 14V)
BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Ignition switch: OFF]
104 L/OR Throttle control motor relay (11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch: ON] 0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped 0.5 - 1.0V
Accelerator pedal position ● Accelerator pedal: Fully released
106 R/B
sensor 1 [Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped 3.9 - 4.7V
● Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Fuel tank temperature sen-
107 PU/W [Engine is running] Output voltage varies with fuel
sor
tank temperature.
[Ignition switch: ON]
ICC brake switch Approximately 0V
(models with ICC system) ● Brake pedal: Depressed
108 SB
ASCD brake switch [Ignition switch: ON] BATTERY VOLTAGE
(models with ASCD system) (11 - 14V)
● Brake pedal: Fully released
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
J
CONSULT-II Function ABS006KX
FUNCTION
Diagnostic test mode Function K
This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
Work support
indications on the CONSULT-II unit.
L
Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
Self-diagnostic results
can be read and erased quickly.*1
Data monitor Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.
M
Input/Output of the specification for Basic fuel schedule, AFM, A/F feedback control value and the
Data monitor (SPEC)
other data monitor items can be read.
CAN diagnostic support
The results of transmit/receive diagnosis of CAN communication can be read.
monitor
Diagnostic Test Mode in which CONSULT-II drives some actuators apart from the ECMs and also
Active test
shifts some parameters in a specified range.
Function test This mode is used to inform customers when their vehicle condition requires periodic maintenance.
DTC & SRT confirmation The status of system monitoring tests and the self-diagnosis status/result can be confirmed.
ECM part number ECM part number can be read.
*1: The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
● Diagnostic trouble codes
● 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
● Freeze frame data
● 1st trip freeze frame data
● System readiness test (SRT) codes
INSPECTION PROCEDURE J
CAUTION:
If CONSULT-II is used with no connection of CONSULT-II CONVERTER, malfunctions might be
detected in self-diagnosis depending on control unit which carry out CAN communication.
K
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect CONSULT-II and CONSULT-II CONVERTER to data
link connector, which is located under LH dash panel near the
L
hood opener handle.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
M
PBIB1570E
MBIB0233E
SEF995X
PBIB2308E
INT/V SOL (B1) [%] ● The control condition of the intake valve
timing control solenoid valve (determined
by ECM according to the input signals) is
INT/V SOL (B2) [%] indicated.
● The advance angle becomes larger as the
value increases.
● The air conditioner relay control condition
AIR COND RLY
× (determined by ECM according to the input
[ON/OFF]
signals) is indicated.
● Indicates the fuel pump relay control condi-
FUEL PUMP RLY
× tion determined by ECM according to the
[ON/OFF]
input signals.
● The control condition of the EVAP canister
vent control valve (determined by ECM
VENT CONT/V
according to the input signals) is indicated.
[ON/OFF]
ON: Closed
OFF: Open
● Indicates the throttle control motor relay
THRTL RELAY
control condition determined by the ECM
[ON/OFF]
according to the input signals.
● The control condition of the cooling fan
(determined by ECM according to the input
signals) is indicated.
COOLING FAN
HI: High speed operation
[HI/MID/LOW/OFF]
MID: Middle speed operation
LOW: Low speed operation
OFF: Stop
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF] ● Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 1 heater determined by
HO2S1 HTR (B2) ECM according to the input signals.
[ON/OFF]
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF] ● Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 2 heater determined by
HO2S2 HTR (B2) ECM according to the input signals.
[ON/OFF]
I/P PULLY SPD ● Indicates the engine speed computed from
[rpm] the turbine revolution sensor signal.
VEHICLE SPEED ● Indicates the vehicle speed computed from
[km/h] or [MPH] the revolution sensor signal.
● Display the condition of idle air volume
learning
IDL A/V LEARN YET: Idle air volume learning has not been
[YET/CMPLT] performed yet.
CMPLT: Idle air volume learning has
already been performed successfully.
PBIB0197E
DESCRIPTION
Generic Scan Tool (OBDII scan tool) complying with SAE J1978 has
8 different functions explained below.
ISO9141 is used as the protocol.
The name GST or Generic Scan Tool is used in this service manual.
SEF139P
This mode gains access to current emission-related data values, including analog inputs
MODE 1 READINESS TESTS
and outputs, digital inputs and outputs, and system status information.
EC
This mode gains access to emission-related data value which were stored by ECM during
MODE 2 (FREEZE DATA) the freeze frame. For details, refer to EC-113, "Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze
Frame Data" .
This mode gains access to emission-related power train trouble codes which were stored C
MODE 3 DTCs
by ECM.
This mode can clear all emission-related diagnostic information. This includes:
● Clear number of diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 1) D
● Clear diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 3)
MODE 4 CLEAR DIAG INFO ● Clear trouble code for freeze frame data (MODE 1)
E
● Clear freeze frame data (MODE 2)
● Reset status of system monitoring test (MODE 1)
● Clear on board monitoring test results (MODE 6 and 7)
F
This mode accesses the results of on board diagnostic monitoring tests of specific com-
MODE 6 (ON BOARD TESTS)
ponents/systems that are not continuously monitored.
This mode enables the off board test drive to obtain test results for emission-related
G
MODE 7 (ON BOARD TESTS) power train components/systems that are continuously monitored during normal driving
conditions.
This mode can close EVAP system in ignition switch ON position (Engine stopped). When
this mode is performed, EVAP canister vent control valve can be closed. H
● EVAP canister vent control valve open
In the following conditions, this mode cannot function.
● Low ambient temperature I
MODE 8 —
● Low battery voltage
● Engine running
J
● Ignition switch OFF
● Low fuel temperature
● Too much pressure is applied to EVAP system
K
This mode enables the off-board test device to request specific vehicle information such
MODE 9 (CALIBRATION ID)
as Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) and Calibration IDs.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE L
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect GST to data link connector, which is located under LH
dash panel near the hood opener handle. M
PBIB1570E
SEF398S
SEF416S
Remarks: A
● Specification data are reference values.
● Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
i.e. Adjust ignition timing with a timing light before monitoring IGN TIMING, because the monitor may show the specification data in EC
spite of the ignition timing not being adjusted to the specification data. This IGN TIMING monitors the data calculated by the ECM
according to the signals input from the camshaft position sensor and other ignition timing related sensors.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
● Run engine and compare CONSULT-II value with the tachometer indica- Almost the same speed as the C
ENG SPEED
tion. tachometer indication.
MAS A/F SE-B1 See EC-131, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
B/FUEL SCHDL See EC-131, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
D
A/F ALPHA-B1
See EC-131, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
A/F ALPHA-B2
E
COOLAN TEMP/S ● Engine: After warming up More than 70°C (158°F)
HO2S1 (B1) Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 0 - 0.3V ←→ Approx. 0.6 -
● Engine: After warming up
HO2S1 (B2) rpm 1.0V
F
● Warm-up condition
● After keeping engine speed
HO2S2 (B1) Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V ←→ Approx. 0.6 -
HO2S2 (B2) between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for quickly 1.0V
1 minute and at idle for 1 minute G
under no load.
LEAN ←→ RICH
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 H
● Engine: After warming up Changes more than 5 times
HO2S1 MNTR (B2) rpm
during 10 seconds.
● Warm-up condition
● After keeping engine speed I
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm
between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for LEAN ←→ RICH
HO2S2 MNTR (B2) quickly
1 minute and at idle for 1 minute
under no load.
J
● Turn drive wheels and compare CONSULT-II value with the speedometer Almost the same speed as the
VEH SPEED SE
indication. speedometer indication
BATTERY VOLT ● Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V K
● Ignition switch: ON Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.5 - 1.0V
ACCEL SEN1
(Engine stopped) Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed 4.0 - 4.8V
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.3 - 1.2V
L
● Ignition switch: ON
ACCEL SEN2*
(Engine stopped) Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed 3.9 - 4.8V
● Ignition switch: ON Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
THRTL SEN1 M
(Engine stopped)
THRTL SEN2* Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
● Shift lever: D
EVAP SYS PRES ● Ignition switch: ON Approx. 1.8 - 4.8V
START SIGNAL ● Ignition switch: ON → START → ON OFF → ON → OFF
A
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1, THRTL SEN 1
Below is the data for “CLSD THL POS”, “ACCEL SEN 1” and “THRTL SEN 1” when depressing the accelera- EC
tor pedal with the ignition switch ON and with selector lever in D position.
The signal of “ACCEL SEN 1” and “THRTL SEN 1” should rise gradually without any intermittent drop or rise
after “CLSD THL POS” is changed from ON to OFF.
C
F
PBIB0198E
ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1), INJ PULSE-B1
Below is the data for “ENG SPEED”, “MAS A/F SE-B1”, “THRTL SEN 1”, “HO2S2 (B1)”, “HO2S1 (B1)” and G
“INJ PULSE-B1” when revving engine quickly up to 4,800 rpm under no load after warming up engine suffi-
ciently.
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary. H
PBIB2445E
PBIB0668E
The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in “DATA MONITOR (SPEC)”
mode of CONSULT-II during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in “DATA MONI- EC
TOR (SPEC)” mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value in
“DATA MONITOR (SPEC)” mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one or
more malfunctions.
The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the C
MIL.
The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
● B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board cor- D
rection)
● A/F ALPHA-B1/B2 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
● MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor) E
NOTE:
Perform “DATA MONITOR (SPEC)” mode in maximum scale display.
K
1. Perform EC-83, "Basic Inspection" .
2. Confirm that the testing conditions indicated above are met.
3. Select “B/FUEL SCHDL”, “A/F ALPHA-B1”, “A/F ALPHA-B2” L
and “MAS A/F SE-B1” in “DATA MONITOR (SPEC)” mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value. M
5. If NG, go to EC-132, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF601Z
SEF613ZD
EC
SEF768Z
SEF615ZA
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the malfunction resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's EC
complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occur-
rences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may
not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the
specific malfunctioning area. C
>> GO TO 2. H
TBWM0217E
1. INSPECTION START I
Start engine.
Is engine running?
J
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 8.
No >> GO TO 2.
K
2. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and then ON. L
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 109 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Battery voltage M
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
MBIB0015E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1610E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10. H
NG >> GO TO 12.
I
PBIB1191E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1870E
Description ABS006L9
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006LA
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
EC
TBWM0218E
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator EC
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed and piston position
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Intake valve Intake valve timing control
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature timing control solenoid valve C
Wheel sensor* Vehicle speed
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line
D
PBIB1102E
J
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing control solenoid K
valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake valve to
increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.
L
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006LF
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. Detecting condition Possible cause
name
P0011
0011 ● Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
(Bank 1) Intake valve timing There is a gap between angle of target and ● Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
P0021 control performance phase-control angle degree. ● Accumulation of debris to the signal pick-up
0021 portion of the camshaft
(Bank 2)
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Intake valve timing control The signal is not energized to the solenoid valve and the valve control does not function.
CAUTION:
Always drive at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC P0011 or P0021 is displayed with DTC P1111 or P1136, first perform trouble diagnosis for
DTC P1111 or P1136. Refer to EC-408 .
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Maintain the following conditions for at least 6 consecutive sec-
onds. Hold the accelerator pedal as steady as possible.
VHCL SPEED SE 100 - 120 km/h (63 - 75 MPH)
ENG SPEED 2,000 - 4,000 rpm
COOLAN TEMP/S 60 - 120°C (140 - 248°F)
SEF353Z
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 7.3 msec
Selector lever D position
4. Stop vehicle with engine running and let engine idle for 10 seconds.
5. If the 1st trip DTC is detected, go toEC-148, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If the 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
6. Maintain the following conditions for at least 20 consecutive seconds.
ENG SPEED 1,700 - 3,175 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)
COOLAN TEMP/S 70 - 105°C (158 - 221°F)
Selector lever 1st or 2nd position
Driving vehicle uphill
Driving location uphill (Increased engine load will help maintain the driving
conditions required for this test.)
7. If the 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-148, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
EC
SEC905C
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator EC
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed Heated oxygen sensor 1
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
heater control
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature C
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine speed
and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine is
started. D
OPERATION
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater E
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 after warming up ON
F
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006LK
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-154, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “with CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0283E
Approximately 8V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
24 L ● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm
heater (bank 1)
PBIB0519E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
EC
TBWM0284E
Approximately 8V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
2 L ● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm
heater (bank 2)
PBIB0519E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
EC
PBIB1559E
H
PBIB0969E
PBIB0970E
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator EC
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature heater control C
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed, D
amount of intake air and engine coolant temperature.
OPERATION
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater E
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 rpm after the following conditions are met.
F
● Engine: After warming up
ON
● Keeping the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1
minute and at idle for 1 minute under no load
G
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006LS
Trouble diagnosis K
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
P0037
0037 The current amperage in the heated oxygen sen- ● Harness or connectors
Heated oxygen L
(Bank 1) sor 2 heater circuit is out of the normal range. (The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater circuit is
sensor 2 heater open or shorted.)
P0057 (An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
control circuit low
0057 through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.) ● Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
(Bank 2) M
P0038
0038 The current amperage in the heated oxygen sen- ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sor 2 heater circuit is out of the normal range. (The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater circuit is
sensor 2 heater (An excessively high voltage signal is sent to shorted.)
P0058 control circuit high ECM through the heated oxygen sensor 2
0058 heater.) ● Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
(Bank 2)
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 11V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start the engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 rpm
and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-162, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. SEF176Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0285E
EC
TBWM0286E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1576E
PBIB0969E H
PBIB0970E
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake EC
flow. The mass air flow sensor controls the temperature of the hot
wire to a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot wire is
reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater
the heat loss. C
Therefore, the electric current supplied to hot wire is changed to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire as air flow increases. The
ECM detects the air flow by means of this current change. D
PBIB1604E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006M0
SEF174Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
If engine cannot be started, go to EC-169, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Check the voltage of “MAS A/F SE-B1” with “DATA MONITOR”.
5. Increases engine speed to about 4,000 rpm.
6. Monitor the linear voltage rise in response to engine speed
increases.
If NG, go to EC-169, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
SEF243Y
SEF534P
J
TBWM0287E
1. INSPECTION START
J
Which malfunction (A or B) is duplicated?
A or B
A >> GO TO 3. K
B >> GO TO 2.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1565E
PBIB1168E
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT E
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 4 and ECM terminal 51.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
F
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG G
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
H
8. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-172, "Component Inspection" .
I
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
J
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" . K
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot wire for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation ABS006M7
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake EC
flow. The mass air flow sensor controls the temperature of the hot
wire to a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot wire is
reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater
the heat loss. C
Therefore, electric current is supplied to hot wire is changed to main-
tain the temperature of the hot wire as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change. D
PBIB1604E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006M9
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-176, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-176, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-176, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0287E
1. INSPECTION START
Which malfunction (P0102 or P0103) is duplicated?
P0102 or P0103
P0102 >> GO TO 2.
P0103 >> GO TO 3.
PBIB2195E
E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections. F
J
PBIB1565E
PBIB1168E
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 4 and ECM terminal 51.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
● Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
The intake air temperature sensor is built-into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
PBIB1604E
<Reference data>
Intake air temperature
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
°C (°F)
25 (77) 3.32 1.94 - 2.06
80 (176) 1.23 0.295 - 0.349
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 34 (Intake air
temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output SEF012P
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006MH
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
Intake air tempera-
P0112 An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
ture sensor circuit
0112 sent to ECM. ● Harness or connectors
low input
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
Intake air tempera-
P0113 An excessively high voltage from the sensor is ● Intake air temperature sensor
ture sensor circuit
0113 sent to ECM.
high input
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-183, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
EC
TBWM0288E
E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
F
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1565E
K
3. Check voltage between mass air flow sensor terminal 5 and
ground.
Voltage: Approximately 5V L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors. M
PBIB1169E
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between mass air flow sensor terminal 6 and ECM terminal 67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Revision: 2004 November EC-183 2004 FX35/FX45
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
[VQ35DE]
4. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-184, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
PBIB1604E
SEF012P
SEF594K
E
<Reference data>
Engine coolant temperature
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ F
°C (°F)
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00 G
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 73 (Engine
coolant temperature sensor) and ground. H
CAUTION: SEF012P
Engine coolant temper- Just as ignition switch is turned ON or START 40°C (104°F)
ature sensor circuit More than approx. 4 minutes after ignition ON or
80°C (176°F)
START
40 - 80°C (104 - 176°F)
Except as shown above
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling fan operates
while engine is running.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-188, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0289E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1563E
PBIB0080E
L
PBIB2005E
M
<Reference data>
Engine coolant
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
temperature °C (°F)
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: This data is reference value and are measured between ECM terminal 73
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor. SEF012P
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-193, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0429E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1557E
PBIB0082E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
C
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
D
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 5 and ECM terminal 66. E
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
F
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. G
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT H
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 69 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
I
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG J
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
K
9. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-196, "Component Inspection" .
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
M
10. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next PBIB1608E
step.
7. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Removal and Installation ABS00CH0
NOTE:
If DTC P0125 is displayed with P0117 or P0118, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0117 or EC
P0118. Refer to EC-185 .
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant C
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases. D
SEF594K
F
<Reference data>
Engine coolant
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
temperature °C (°F) G
-10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
H
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 73 (Engine I
coolant temperature sensor) and ground. SEF012P
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam- J
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006NB
K
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
L
● Voltage sent to ECM from the sensor is not ● Harness or connectors
Insufficient engine cool- practical, even when some time has passed (High resistance in the circuit)
P0125 after starting the engine.
ant temperature for
0125 ● Engine coolant temperature sensor
closed loop fuel control ● Engine coolant temperature is insufficient for M
closed loop fuel control. ● Thermostat
CAUTION:
Be careful not to overheat engine.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Check that “COOLAN TEMP/S” is above 10°C (50°F).
If it is above 10°C (50°F), the test result will be OK.
If it is below 10°C (50°F), go to following step.
4. Start engine and run it for 65 minutes at idle speed.
If “COOLAN TEMP/S” increases to more than 10°C (50°F)
within 65 minutes, stop engine because the test result will
be OK.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-198, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00CH1
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
I
PBIB2005E
<Reference data> J
Engine coolant
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
temperature °C (°F)
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9 K
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
L
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 73
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor. SEF012P M
Removal and Installation ABS006NF
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
PBIB1604E
<Reference data>
Intake air temperature
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
°C (°F)
25 (77) 3.32 1.94 - 2.06
80 (176) 1.23 0.295 - 0.349
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 34 (Intake air
temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output SEF012P
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006NH
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
TESTING CONDITION:
This test may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road
test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Wait until engine coolant temperature is less than 90°C (194°F)
a. Turn ignition switch ON.
secutive seconds. D
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-201, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST E
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006NJ
F
1. CHECK GROUND CONNECTIONS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten ground three screws on the body. Refer to EC-141, "Ground Inspection" . G
J
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
K
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
PBIB1604E
SEF012P
Engine coolant temperature has not risen enough to open the thermostat even though the engine has run long
enough. EC
This is due to a leak in the seal or the thermostat stuck open.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Thermostat
C
The engine coolant temperature does not
P0128 ● Leakage from sealing portion of thermo-
Thermostat function reach to specified temperature even though
0128 stat
the engine has run long enough.
● Engine coolant temperature sensor
D
NOTE: E
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: F
● For best results, perform at ambient temperature of –10°C (14°F) or higher.
● For best results, perform at engine coolant temperature of –10°C (14°F) to 60°C (140°F).
G
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Replace thermostat with new one. Refer to CO-26, "WATER INLET AND THERMOSTAT ASSEMBLY" .
Use only a genuine NISSAN thermostat as a replacement. If an incorrect thermostat is used, the MIL may
H
come on.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Select “COOLAN TEMP/S” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with
I
CONSULT-II.
4. Check that the “COOLAN TEMP/S” is above 60°C (140°F).
If it is below 60°C (140°F), go to following step.
If it is above 60°C (140°F), cool down the engine to less than J
60°C (140°F), then retry from step 1.
5. Drive vehicle for 10 consecutive minutes under the following
conditions. K
PBIB2005E
<Reference data>
Engine coolant
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
temperature °C (°F)
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 73
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor. SEF012P
SEF463R
H
SEF288D
SEF301UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor An excessively high voltage from the sensor is (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0152 1 circuit high voltage sent to ECM.
● Heated oxygen sensor 1
0152
(Bank 2)
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-210, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0290E
EC
TBWM0291E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1577E
>> GO TO 3.
EC
PBIB1559E
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor J
P0132 35 1 1
P0152 16 1 2
K
Continuity should exist.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
L
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor M
P0132 35 1 1
P0152 16 1 2
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
EC
SEF648Y
CAUTION: D
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m
(19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor E
Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
F
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
G
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
H
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m
(19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one. K
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor
Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
L
Removal and Installation ABS006NY
SEF463R
SEF288D
SEF010V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause A
P0133 ● Harness or connectors
0133 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) ● Heated oxygen sensor 1 EC
● Fuel pressure
Heated oxygen sensor The response of the voltage signal from the ● Injector
P0153 1 circuit slow response sensor takes more than the specified time.
0153
● Intake air leaks C
(Bank 2) ● Exhaust gas leaks
● PCV valve
● Mass air flow sensor D
CAUTION: E
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at F
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Always perform at a temperature above −10°C (14°F). G
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
H
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “HO2S1 (B1) P0133” or “HO2S1 (B2) P0153” of “HO2S1” in “DTC
I
WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch “START”.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes. J
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
K
SEF338Z
step 2.
SEF658Y
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1(B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
– The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V more
than 5 times within 10 seconds.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V → 0.6 - 1.0V → 0 - 0.3V
2 0 - 0.3V → 0.6 - 1.0V → 0 - 0.3V → 0.6 - 1.0V
times: → 0 - 0.3V
4. If NG, go to EC-220, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1107E
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0290E
EC
TBWM0291E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1577E
>> GO TO 3.
PBIB1165E
E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace. F
SEF968Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 detected? PBIB1565E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or DTC P0172 (Refer to EC-256 or EC-265 ).
No >> GO TO 6.
PBIB1559E
E
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
G
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 H
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
I
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and J
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load. K
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time. L
● The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
SEF463R
SEF288D
SEF237U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
Heated oxygen sensor ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) The voltage from the sensor is constantly
1 circuit no activity (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0154 approx. 0.3V.
detected ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
0154
(Bank 2)
A
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at EC
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle. C
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
D
2. Select “HO2S1 (B1) P0134” or “HO2S1 (B2) P0154” of “HO2S1” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Touch “START”.
E
4. Let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 4. F
PBIB0544E
H
5. When the following conditions are met, “TESTING” will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until “TESTING” changes to “COMPLETED”. (It will I
take approximately 10 to 60 seconds.)
ENG SPEED 1,200 - 3,100 rpm
J
Vehicle speed More than 64 km/h (40 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.0 - 17.0 msec
Selector lever Suitable position K
If “TESTING” is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from PBIB0545E
step 2.
6. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG L
RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-232, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
M
SEC750C
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
– The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 to 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-232, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1107E
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0290E
EC
TBWM0291E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
EC
PBIB1559E
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst 1, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
SEF327R
SEF305UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor An excessively high voltage from the sensor is (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0158 2 circuit high voltage sent to ECM.
● Heated oxygen sensor 2
0158
(Bank 2)
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
C
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
D
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 2 minutes. E
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-137, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. SEF174Y
WITH GST F
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1
TBWM0292E
TBWM0293E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. L
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
SEF174Y
E
6. Select “FUEL INJECTION” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode, and select
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
F
H
SEF662Y
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%. I
L
PBIB0796E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.63V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%. M
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads (using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12) and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst 1, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank. EC
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt- C
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for D
engine control operation.
SEF327R
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006OQ
SEF302U
L
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0139 ● Harness or connectors
M
0139 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) ● Heated oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor It takes more time for the sensor to respond
P0159 2 circuit slow response between rich and lean than the specified time. ● Fuel pressure
0159 ● Fuel injector
(Bank 2)
● Intake air leaks
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
For better results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C
(158°F). SEF174Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
7. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P0139” or “HO2S2 (B2) P0159” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
8. Start engine and following the instruction of CONSULT-II.
PBIB0115E
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
BANK 1
TBWM0292E
TBWM0293E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. L
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
SEF968Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 detected? PBIB1565E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174 or P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-256 or EC-265 .
No >> GO TO 3.
SEF174Y
SEF662Y
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.
PBIB0796E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.63V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
6. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.63V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.63V at step 6, step 7 is not neces-
sary.
7. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with “OD” OFF.
The voltage should be below 0.48V at least once during this PBIB1607E
procedure.
8. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
EC
With the Air-Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (the actual mixture ratio is too lean.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and lights up the MIL (2 trip detection logic).
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas Fuel injection
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Fuel injector
(Mixture ratio feedback signal) control
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
P0171 ● Intake air leaks
0171 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
(Bank 1)
● Fuel Injector
● Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
Fuel injection system ● Exhaust gas leaks
too lean ● The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
P0174 ● Incorrect fuel pressure
large. (The mixture ratio is too lean.)
0174 ● Lack of fuel
(Bank 2)
● Mass air flow sensor
● Incorrect PCV hose connection
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching “CLEAR”.
5. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 should be detected at this
stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to Diagnostic Procedure,
EC-260 .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine
starts, go to EC-260, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not SEF968Y
start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
BANK 1
TBWM0294E
EC
TBWM0295E
PBIB1165E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
PBIB1559E
E
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor G
P0171 35 1 1
P0174 16 1 2
H
Continuity should exist.
E
PBIB0133E
Without CONSULT-II F
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard. G
PBIB1986E
J
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for INJECTORS, EC-597 . K
8. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle. L
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect all injector harness connectors.
4. Remove injector gallery assembly. Refer to EM-45, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" . M
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
5. For DTC P0171, reconnect injector harness connectors on bank 1.
For DTC P0174, reconnect injector harness connectors on bank 2.
6. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
7. Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
8. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
For DTC P0171, make sure that fuel sprays out from injectors
on bank 1.
For DTC P0174, make sure that fuel sprays out from injectors
on bank 2.
Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each injector.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace injectors from which fuel does not spray out.
Always replace O-ring with new ones. PBIB1726E
With the Air-Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The EC
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (the actual mixture ratio is too rich.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and lights up the MIL (2 trip detection logic). C
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas Fuel injection D
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Fuel injector
(Mixture ratio feedback signal) control
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause E
name
P0172 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
0172
● Fuel injection system does not operate properly. ● Fuel injector
(Bank 1) Fuel injection system F
● The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too ● Exhaust gas leaks
P0175 too rich
large. (The mixture ratio is too rich.) ● Incorrect fuel pressure
0175
(Bank 2) ● Mass air flow sensor G
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS006P3
NOTE: H
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II I
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CON- J
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching “CLEAR”.
5. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. K
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0172, P0175 should be detected at this stage,
if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-269, "Diagnostic Proce- L
dure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too. M
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-269, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine SEF968Y
does not start, remove spark plugs and check for fouling, etc.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0294E
TBWM0295E
E
PBIB1165E
OK or NG
F
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG H
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
I
PBIB1559E
PBIB0133E
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
PBIB1986E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for INJECTORS, EC-597 .
8. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Remove injector assembly. Refer to EM-45, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
2. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
3. Disconnect all injector harness connectors.
4. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
5. Prepare pans or saucers under each injectors.
6. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one.
The fuel tank temperature sensor is used to detect the fuel tempera-
ture inside the fuel tank. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from EC
the ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the fuel temper-
ature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to the
change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases as temperature increases. C
PBIB1572E
E
<Reference data>
Fluid temperature Voltage* Resistance
F
°C (°F) V kΩ
20 (68) 3.5 2.3 - 2.7
50 (122) 2.2 0.79 - 0.90 G
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 107 (fuel tank
temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION: H
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output SEF012P
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground. I
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006P7
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause J
Rationally incorrect voltage from the sensor is ● Harness or connectors
Fuel tank temperature
P0181 sent to ECM, compared with the voltage sig- (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
sensor circuit range/
0181 nals from engine coolant temperature sensor K
performance ● Fuel tank temperature sensor
and intake air temperature sensor.
L
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
M
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 10 seconds.
If the result is NG, go to EC-276, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If the result is OK, go to following step.
4. Check “COOLAN TEMP/S” value.
If “COOLAN TEMP/S” is less than 60°C (140°F), the result will
be OK.
If “COOLAN TEMP/S” is above 60°C (140°F), go to the following
step.
5. Cool engine down until “COOLAN TEMP/S” is less than 60°C
(140°F). SEF174Y
EC
TBWH0109E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1572E
4. Check voltage between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
terminal 4 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Approximately 5V
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0932E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connector.
J
7. CHECK FUEL TANK TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-277, "Component Inspection" . K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace fuel level sensor unit. L
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-135, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" . M
PBIB0931E
The fuel tank temperature sensor is used to detect the fuel tempera-
ture inside the fuel tank. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from EC
the ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the fuel temper-
ature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to the
change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases as temperature increases. C
PBIB1572E
E
<Reference data>
Fluid temperature Voltage* Resistance
F
°C (°F) V kΩ
20 (68) 3.5 2.3 - 2.7
50 (122) 2.2 0.79 - 0.90 G
*: This data is reference value and is measured between ECM terminal 107 (fuel tank
temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION: H
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output SEF012P
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground. I
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006PE
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause J
P0182 Fuel tank temperature An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
● Harness or connectors
0182 sensor circuit low input sent to ECM.
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
P0183 Fuel tank temperature An excessively high voltage from the sensor is K
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
0183 sensor circuit high input sent to ECM.
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWH0109E
E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
F
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1572E
M
4. Check voltage between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
terminal 4 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Approximately 5V
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0932E
5. CHECK FUEL TANK TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect “unified meter and A/C amp.” harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” terminal 5 and “unified meter and
A/C amp.” terminal 36. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connector.
PBIB0931E
D
Removal and Installation ABS006PJ
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-287, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0428E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1557E
PBIB0082E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
C
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
D
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 5 and ECM terminal 66. E
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
F
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. G
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT H
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 50 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
I
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG J
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
K
9. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-290, "Component Inspection" .
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
M
10. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next PBIB1608E
step.
7. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Removal and Installation ABS00CHD
When a misfire occurs, engine speed will fluctuate. If the engine speed fluctuates enough to cause the crank- EC
shaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) signal to vary, ECM can determine that a misfire is occurring.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Engine speed On board diagnosis of misfire C
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle in safe manner according to traffic conditions and obey all traffic laws when driv-
ing.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
The similar conditions to (1st trip) Freeze Frame Data means the vehicle operation that the following condi-
tions should be satisfied at the same time.
Engine speed Engine speed in the freeze frame data ± 400 rpm
Vehicle speed Vehicle speed in the freeze frame data ± 10 km/h (6 MPH)
When the freeze frame data shows lower than 70 °C (158 °F),
Engine coolant temperature T should be lower than 70 °C (158 °F).
(T) condition When the freeze frame data shows higher than or equal to 70 °C (158 °F),
T should be higher than or equal to 70 °C (158 °F).
The time to driving varies according to the engine speed in the freeze frame data.
Refer to the following table.
Engine speed Time
Around 1,000 rpm Approximately 10 minutes
Around 2,000 rpm Approximately 5 minutes
More than 3,000 rpm Approximately 3.5 minutes
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006PU
PBIB0133E
E
Without CONSULT-II
When disconnecting each injector harness connector one at a time,
is there any cylinder which does not produce a momentary engine F
speed drop?
PBIB1561E
I
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 4.
No >> GO TO 7. J
4. CHECK INJECTOR
K
Does each injector make an operating sound at idle?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5. L
No >> Check injector(s) and circuit(s). Refer to EC-597,
"INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
M
PBIB1986E
SEF575Q
SEF156I
>> GO TO 15.
PBIB1564E
E
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006PW
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
I
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
J
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
K
2. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-299, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
L
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0296E
2. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
I
1. Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 15 and knock
sensor terminal 1. J
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power. K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
L
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB1564E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
KNOCK SENSOR
Check resistance between knock sensor terminal 1 and ground.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more
than 10 MΩ.
Resistance: Approximately 532 - 588 kΩ [at 20°C (68°F)]
CAUTION:
Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or phys-
ically damaged. Use only new ones.
SEF111Y
KNOCK SENSOR A
Refer to EM-240, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
EC
The crankshaft position sensor (POS) is located on the oil pan facing
the gear teeth (cogs) of the signal plate. It detects the fluctuation of
the engine revolution.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth
cause the gap with the sensor to change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
changes.
The ECM receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation of
PBIB0562E
the engine revolution.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006Q3
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal
is not detected by the ECM during the first
few seconds of engine cranking.
● Harness or connectors
● The proper pulse signal from the crankshaft (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0335 Crankshaft position
position sensor (POS) is not sent to ECM
0335 sensor (POS) circuit ● Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
while the engine is running.
● Signal plate
● The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal
is not in the normal pattern during engine
running.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-304, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0297E
Approximately 1.6V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1041E
Crankshaft position sensor
13 Y
(POS)
Approximately 1.4V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1042E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1575E
PBIB0664E
H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
4. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. M
2. Check harness continuity between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 3 and ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
PBIB0563E
F
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]
1 (+) - 2 (-) G
1 (+) - 3 (-) Except 0 or ∞
2 (+) - 3 (-)
H
I
PBIB0564E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0340 ● Harness or connectors
● The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
0340 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
for the first few seconds during engine
(Bank 1) ● Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
cranking.
Camshaft position sen- ● Camshaft (Intake)
● The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
P0345 sor (PHASE) circuit
during engine running. ● Starter motor (Refer to SC-10 .)
0345
(Bank 2) ● The cylinder No. signal is not in the normal ● Starting system circuit (Refer to SC-10 .)
pattern during engine running.
● Dead (Weak) battery
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-312, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Maintaining engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5
seconds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-312, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0298E
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1039E
Camshaft position sensor
33 R/L
(PHASE) (bank 1)
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1040E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
EC
TBWM0299E
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1039E
Camshaft position sensor
14 BR
(PHASE) (bank 2)
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1040E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
EC
PBIB1568E
L
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
M
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 1 and ground.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
SEC905C
PBIB0563E
F
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]
1 (+) - 2 (-) G
1 (+) - 3 (-) Except 0 or ∞
2 (+) - 3 (-)
H
I
PBIB0564E
PBIB1166E
The ECM monitors the switching frequency ratio of heated oxygen sensors 1 and 2.
A three way catalyst 1 with high oxygen storage capacity will indicate a low switching frequency of heated oxy-
gen sensor 2. As oxygen storage capacity decreases, the heated oxygen sensor 2 switching frequency will
increase.
When the frequency ratio of heated oxygen sensors 1 and 2 approaches a specified limit value, the three way
catalyst 1 malfunction is diagnosed.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0420 ● Three way catalyst 1
0420 ● Exhaust tube
(Bank 1) ● Three way catalyst 1 does not operate prop- ● Intake air leaks
Catalyst system effi- erly.
● Fuel injector
P0430 ciency below threshold ● Three way catalyst 1 does not have enough
0430 oxygen storage capacity. ● Fuel injector leaks
(Bank 2) ● Spark plug
● Improper ignition timing
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
Do not hold engine speed for more than the specified minutes below.
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C
(158°F). SEF189Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
7. Open engine hood.
SEF940Z
D
11. Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and maintain it until
“INCMP” of “CATALYST” changes to “CMPLT” (It will take
approximately 5 minutes). E
If not “CMPLT”, stop engine and cool it down to less than 70°C
(158°F) and then retest from step 1.
F
G
SEF941Z
SEF535Z K
Overall Function Check ABS006QJ
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the three way catalyst 1. During this check, a DTC might L
not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. M
2. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
3. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
4. Open engine hood.
5. Set voltmeters probes between ECM terminals 35 [HO2S1
(bank 1) signal], 16 [HO2S1 (bank 2) signal] and ground, and
ECM terminals 74 [HO2S2 (bank 1) signal], 55 [HO2S2 (bank 2)
signal] and ground.
6. Keep engine speed at 2,000 rpm constant under no load.
PBIB1107E
PBIB1165E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
H
PBIB1172E
SEF575Q
NOTE:
If DTC P0441 is displayed with other DTC such as P2122, P2123, P2127, P2128 or P2138, first perform EC
trouble diagnosis for other DTC.
H
PBIB1026E
In this evaporative emission (EVAP) control system, purge flow occurs during non-closed throttle conditions.
Purge volume is related to air intake volume. Under normal purge conditions (non-closed throttle), the EVAP I
canister purge volume control solenoid valve is open to admit purge flow. Purge flow exposes the EVAP con-
trol system pressure sensor to intake manifold vacuum.
J
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006QM
Under normal conditions (non-closed throttle), sensor output voltage indicates if pressure drop and purge flow
are adequate. If not, a malfunction is determined.
K
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve stuck closed L
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
and the circuit
● Loose, disconnected or improper con- M
EVAP control system does not operate prop- nection of rubber tube
P0441 EVAP control system erly, EVAP control system has a leak between ● Blocked rubber tube
0441 incorrect purge flow intake manifold and EVAP control system pres-
● Cracked EVAP canister
sure sensor.
● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve circuit
● Accelerator pedal position sensor
● Blocked purge port
● EVAP canister vent control valve
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
PBIB0826E
Use this procedure to check the overall monitoring function of the EVAP control system purge flow monitoring.
During this check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Lift up drive wheels.
2. Start engine (TCS switch or VDC switch OFF) and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and wait at least 70 seconds.
5. Set voltmeter probes to ECM terminals 32 (EVAP control system
pressure sensor signal) and ground.
6. Check EVAP control system pressure sensor value at idle speed
and note it.
7. Establish and maintain the following conditions for at least 1
minute.
Air conditioner switch ON
Headlamp switch ON
Rear window defogger switch ON
PBIB1109E
Engine speed Approx. 3,000 rpm
Gear position Any position other than P, N or R
With CONSULT-II
1. Disconnect vacuum hose connected to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve at EVAP ser- F
vice port and install vacuum gauge. For the location of EVAP service port, refer to EC-644, "EVAPORA-
TIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
2. Start engine and let it idle. G
3. Select “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm.
5. Touch “Qd” and “Qu” on CONSULT-II screen to adjust “PURG H
VOL CONT/V” opening and check vacuum existence.
PURG VOL CONT/V Vacuum
I
100% Should exist.
0% Should not exist.
OK or NG J
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0147E
K
SEF367U
SEF368U
PBIB0147E
Clean EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube) using air blower.
>> GO TO 14.
This diagnosis detects leaks in the EVAP purge line using engine intake manifold vacuum.
If pressure does not increase, the ECM will check for leaks in the line between the fuel tank and EVAP canister
purge volume control solenoid valve, under the following Vacuum test conditions.
The EVAP canister vent control valve is closed to shut the EVAP purge line off. The EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve will then be opened to depressurize the EVAP purge line using intake manifold
vacuum. After this occurs, the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve will be closed.
PBIB1026E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Incorrect fuel tank vacuum relief valve
● Incorrect fuel filler cap used
● Fuel filler cap remains open or fails to close.
● Foreign matter caught in fuel filler cap.
● Leak is in line between intake manifold and
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve.
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister vent
control valve.
● EVAP canister or fuel tank leaks
● EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube) leaks
EVAP control system EVAP control system has a leak, EVAP ● EVAP purge line rubber tube bent
P0442
small leak detected control system does not operate prop-
0442 ● Loose or disconnected rubber tube
(negative pressure) erly.
● EVAP canister vent control valve and the circuit
● EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve and the circuit
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
● O-ring of EVAP canister vent control valve is
missing or damaged
● EVAP canister is saturated with water
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Fuel level sensor and the circuit
● Refueling EVAP vapor cut valve
● ORVR system leaks
NOTE: C
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
D
● Perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” when the fuel level is between 1/4 and 3/4 full, and vehicle is
placed on flat level surface.
● Always perform test at a temperature of 0 to 30°C (32 to 86°F). E
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. F
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that the following conditions are met.
COOLAN TEMP/S: 0 - 70°C (32 - 158°F) G
INT/A TEMP SE: 0 - 30°C (32 - 86°F)
5. Select “EVAP SML LEAK P0442/P1442” of “EVAPORATIVE SYSTEM” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode
with CONSULT-II. H
Follow the instruction displayed.
PBIB0829E
NOTE: L
If the engine speed cannot be maintained within the range displayed on the CONSULT-II screen, go to
EC-83, "Basic Inspection" .
6. Make sure that “OK” is displayed. M
If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-328, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
NOTE:
Make sure that EVAP hoses are connected to EVAP canister
purge volume control solenoid valve properly.
SEC763C
WITH GST
NOTE:
Be sure to read the explanation of EC-64, "Driving Pattern" before driving vehicle.
1. Start engine.
2. Drive vehicle according to EC-64, "Driving Pattern" .
3. Stop vehicle.
SEF915U
D
PBIB2006E
SEF916U
H
NOTE:
Improper installation of the EVAP service port adapter to the EVAP service port may cause leaking.
I
PEF917U
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details.
Refer to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING"
.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF200U
PBIB1611E
F
3. Pressurize the EVAP line using pressure pump with 1.3 to 2.7 kPa (10 to 20 mmHg, 0.39 to 0.79 inHg),
then remove pump and EVAP service port adapter.
NOTE:
● Never use compressed air or a high pressure pump. G
Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in the system.
●
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak H
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details. Refer
to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
I
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
J
SEF200U
K
8. CHECK EVAP CANISTER VENT CONTROL VALVE
Check the following. L
● EVAP canister vent control valve is installed properly.
Refer to EC-647, "Removal and Installation" .
● EVAP canister vent control valve. M
Refer to EC-646, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair or replace EVAP canister vent control valve and O-ring.
PBIB1031E
12. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Disconnect vacuum hose to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve at EVAP service port.
2. Start engine.
3. Perform “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode.
4. Touch “Qu” on CONSULT-II screen to increase “PURG VOL
CONT/V” opening to 100%.
5. Check vacuum hose for vacuum when revving engine up to
2,000 rpm.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 14.
PBIB0147E
>> GO TO 20.
Description ABS006QT
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION EC
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Engine speed*1
C
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
D
Battery Battery voltage*1
EVAP canister EVAP canister purge vol-
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
purge flow control ume control solenoid valve
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position E
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Heated oxygen sensors 1
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel tank temperature sensor Fuel temperature in fuel tank F
Wheel sensor*2 Vehicle speed
*1:ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
*2: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line. G
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP H
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes. I
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
J
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve. K
SEF337U
M
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006QU
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
EVAP canister purge volume (The solenoid valve circuit is open or
P0444 An excessively low voltage signal is sent shorted.)
control solenoid valve circuit
0444 to ECM through the valve
open ● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
● Harness or connectors
EVAP canister purge volume (The solenoid valve circuit is shorted.)
P0445 An excessively high voltage signal is sent
control solenoid valve circuit
0445 to ECM through the valve ● EVAP canister purge volume control
shorted
solenoid valve
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 13 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-339, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0300E
[Engine is running]
● Idle speed
SEC990C
EVAP canister purge vol-
45 GY
ume control solenoid valve BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
SEC991C
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch: OFF]
0 - 1.5V
● For a few seconds after turning ignition
ECM relay switch OFF
111 W/B
(Self shut-off)
[Ignition switch: OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● More than a few seconds after turning igni- (11 - 14V)
tion switch OFF
119 R BATTERY VOLTAGE
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch: ON]
120 R (11 - 14V)
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
1. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR- A
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. EC
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. C
E
PBIB2006E
PBIB0148E
I
3. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 45 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 4.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0147E
PBIB0149E
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Air passage continuity
Condition
between A and B
12V direct current supply between
Yes
terminals 1 and 2
No supply No
PBIB0150E
EC
The EVAP canister vent control valve is located on the EVAP canis-
ter and is used to seal the canister vent.
This solenoid valve responds to signals from the ECM. When the
ECM sends an ON signal, the coil in the solenoid valve is energized.
A plunger will then move to seal the canister vent. The ability to seal
the vent is necessary for the on board diagnosis of other evaporative
emission control system components.
This solenoid valve is used only for diagnosis, and usually remains
opened.
When the vent is closed, under normal purge conditions, the evapo-
rative emission control system is depressurized and allows EVAP
PBIB1263E
Control System diagnosis.
PBIB1611E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
P0447 EVAP canister vent con- An improper voltage signal is sent to ECM (The valve circuit is open or shorted.)
0447 trol valve circuit open through EVAP canister vent control valve.
● EVAP canister vent control valve
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 8 seconds.
D
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-345, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
E
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWH0110E
PBIB0151E K
PBIB1611E
PBIB0152E
5. CHECK EVAP CANISTER VENT CONTROL VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 117 and EVAP canister vent control valve terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1033E
7. Clean the air passage (portion A to B ) of EVAP canister vent control valve using an air blower.
8. Perform step 6 again.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove EVAP canister vent control valve from EVAP canister.
2. Check portion B of EVAP canister vent control valve for being
rusted.
PBIB1033E
3. Check air passage continuity and operation delay time under the
following conditions.
Make sure new O-ring is installed properly.
Condition Air passage continuity between A and B
12V direct current supply between
No
terminals 1 and 2
OFF Yes
Operation takes less than 1 second.
The EVAP control system pressure sensor detects pressure in the purge line. The sensor output voltage to the
ECM increases as pressure increases. EC
E
PBIB1611E
PBIB1207E I
NOTE:
If DTC P0451 is displayed with DTC P1229, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1229. Refer to EC- L
489, "DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause M
EVAP control system ● Harness or connectors
P0451 ECM detects a sloshing signal from the EVAP
pressure sensor perfor-
0451 control system pressure sensor ● EVAP control system pressure sensor
mance
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 40 seconds.
NOTE:
Do not depress accelerator pedal even slightly.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-350, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF194Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00CHI
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
EC
PBIB1611E
CAUTION:
● Always calibrate the vacuum pump gauge when using it.
● Do not apply below -93.3 kPa (-700 mmHg, -27.56 inHg) or PBIB1173E
pressure over 101.3 kPa (760 mmHg, 29.92 inHg).
4. If NG, replace EVAP control system pressure sensor.
The EVAP control system pressure sensor detects pressure in the purge line. The sensor output voltage to the
ECM increases as pressure increases.
PBIB1611E
PBIB1207E
NOTE:
If DTC P0452 is displayed with DTC P1229, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1229, Refer to EC-
489, "DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Always perform test at a temperature of 5°C (41°F) or more.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. C
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
D
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Make sure that “FUEL T/TEMP SE” is more than 0°C (32°F).
6. Start engine and wait at least 20 seconds. E
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-355, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
F
G
SEF194Y
WITH GST H
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check that voltage between ECM terminal 107 (Fuel tank tem-
perature sensor signal) and ground is less than 4.2V. I
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and wait at least 20 seconds.
5. Select MODE 7 with GST. J
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-355, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
K
PBIB1110E
TBWH0111E
F
1. CHECK GROUND CONNECTIONS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten ground three screws on the body. Refer to EC-141, "Ground Inspection" . G
J
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
K
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
2. CHECK CONNECTOR L
PBIB1611E
PBIB0138E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK EVAP CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between EVAP control system pressure sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal
67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
CAUTION:
● Always calibrate the vacuum pump gauge when using it.
● Do not apply below -93.3 kPa (-700 mmHg, -27.56 inHg) or PBIB1173E
pressure over 101.3 kPa (760 mmHg, 29.92 inHg).
4. If NG, replace EVAP control system pressure sensor.
The EVAP control system pressure sensor detects pressure in the purge line. The sensor output voltage to the
ECM increases as pressure increases.
PBIB1611E
PBIB1207E
NOTE:
If DTC P0453 is displayed with DTC P1229, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1229. Refer to EC-
489, "DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Always perform test at a temperature of 5°C (41°F) or more.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. C
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
D
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Make sure that “FUEL T/TEMP SE” is more than 0°C (32°F).
6. Wait at least 10 seconds. E
7. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-361, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
F
G
SEF194Y
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. H
2. Check that voltage between ECM terminal 107 (Fuel tank tem-
perature sensor signal) and ground is less than 4.2V.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. I
4. Wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Select MODE 7 with GST.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-361, "Diagnostic Procedure" J
.
K
PBIB1110E
TBWH0111E
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground. A
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
EC
TER-
WIRE
MINAL ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
COLOR
NO.
C
EVAP control system pres-
32 OR [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 1.8 - 4.8V
sure sensor
Sensor power supply
48 LG (EVAP control system pres- [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 5V D
sure sensor)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG K
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
L
2. CHECK CONNECTOR
1. Disconnect EVAP control system pressure sensor harness connector.
M
PBIB1611E
PBIB0138E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK EVAP CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between EVAP control system pressure sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal
67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
PBIB1031E
CAUTION:
● Always calibrate the vacuum pump gauge when using it. E
● Do not apply below -93.3 kPa (-700 mmHg, -27.56 inHg) or PBIB1173E
pressure over 101.3 kPa (760 mmHg, 29.92 inHg).
4. If NG, replace EVAP control system pressure sensor. F
This diagnosis detects a very large leak (fuel filler cap fell off etc.) in EVAP system between the fuel tank and
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
PBIB1026E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Fuel filler cap remains open or fails to
close.
● Incorrect fuel tank vacuum relief valve
● Incorrect fuel filler cap used
● Foreign matter caught in fuel filler cap.
● Leak is in line between intake manifold
and EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve.
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister
vent control valve.
● EVAP canister or fuel tank leaks
EVAP control system has a very large leak ● EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube)
P0455 EVAP control system leaks
such as fuel filler cap fell off, EVAP control sys-
0455 gross leak detected
tem does not operate properly. ● EVAP purge line rubber tube bent.
● Loose or disconnected rubber tube
● EVAP canister vent control valve and the
circuit
● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve and the circuit
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
● O-ring of EVAP canister vent control
valve is missing or damaged.
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Refueling EVAP vapor cut valve
● ORVR system leaks
CAUTION:
● Use only a genuine NISSAN fuel filler cap as a replacement. If an incorrect fuel filler cap is used,
the MIL may come on.
● If the fuel filler cap is not tightened properly, the MIL may come on.
CAUTION:
Never remove fuel filler cap during the DTC Confirmation Procedure. EC
NOTE:
● Make sure that EVAP hoses are connected to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
properly.
C
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
D
● Perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” when the fuel level is between 1/4 and 3/4 full and vehicle is
placed on flat level surface.
● Open engine hood before conducting the following procedures. E
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Tighten fuel filler cap securely until ratcheting sound is heard.
2. Turn ignition switch ON. F
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
G
5. Make sure that the following conditions are met.
COOLAN TEMP/S: 0 - 70°C (32 - 158°F)
INT/A TEMP SE: 0 - 60°C (32 - 140°F)
6. Select “EVAP SML LEAK P0442/P1442” of “EVAPORATIVE SYSTEM” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode H
with CONSULT-II.
Follow the instruction displayed.
I
PBIB0829E L
NOTE:
If the engine speed cannot be maintained within the range displayed on the CONSULT-II screen, go to
EC-83, "Basic Inspection" . M
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed.
If “NG” is displayed, select “SELF-DIAG RESULTS” mode and
make sure that “EVAP GROSS LEAK [P0455]” is displayed. If it
is displayed, refer to EC-368, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If P0442 is displayed, perform Diagnostic Procedure for DTC
P0442 EC-328, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC763C
● If P0442 is displayed on the screen, go to Diagnostic Procedure, for DTC P0442, EC-328 .
● If P0441 is displayed on the screen, go to Diagnostic Procedure for DTC P0441, EC-323 .
SEF915U
>> GO TO 7.
E
7. CHECK EVAP CANISTER VENT CONTROL VALVE
Check the following. F
● EVAP canister vent control valve is installed properly.
Refer to EC-647, "Removal and Installation" .
● EVAP canister vent control valve. G
Refer to EC-347, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. H
NG >> Repair or replace EVAP canister vent control valve and O-ring.
L
PBIB2006E
SEF916U
PEF917U
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details.
Refer to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING"
.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF200U
PBIB1611E
F
3. Pressurize the EVAP line using pressure pump with 1.3 to 2.7 kPa (10 to 20 mmHg, 0.39 to 0.79 inHg),
then remove pump and EVAP service port adapter.
NOTE:
● Never use compressed air or a high pressure pump. G
Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in the system.
●
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak H
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details. Refer
to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
I
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair or replace.
J
SEF200U
K
11. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II L
1. Disconnect vacuum hose to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve at EVAP service port.
2. Start engine.
M
3. Perform “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode.
4. Touch “Qu” on CONSULT-II screen to increase “PURG VOL
CONT/V” opening to 100%.
5. Check vacuum hose for vacuum when revving engine up to
2,000 rpm.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
PBIB0828E
PBIB0828E
This diagnosis detects very small leaks in the EVAP line between fuel tank and EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve, using the intake manifold vacuum in the same way as conventional EVAP small leak
diagnosis.
If ECM judges a leak which corresponds to a very small leak, the very small leak P0456 will be detected.
If ECM judges a leak equivalent to a small leak, EVAP small leak P0442 will be detected.
If ECM judges there are no leaks, the diagnosis will be OK.
PBIB1026E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Incorrect fuel tank vacuum relief valve
● Incorrect fuel filler cap used
● Fuel filler cap remains open or fails to close.
● Foreign matter caught in fuel filler cap.
● Leak is in line between intake manifold and EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister vent con-
trol valve.
● EVAP canister or fuel tank leaks
● EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube) leaks
● EVAP purge line rubber tube bent
Evaporative emission ● EVAP system has a very small leak. ● Loose or disconnected rubber tube
P0456 control system very
0456 small leak (negative ● EVAP system does not operate prop- ● EVAP canister vent control valve and the circuit
pressure check) erly. ● EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve and the circuit
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
● O-ring of EVAP canister vent control valve is miss-
ing or damaged
● EVAP canister is saturated with water
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Refueling EVAP vapor cut valve
● ORVR system leaks
● Fuel level sensor and the circuit
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve
NOTE: C
● If DTC P0456 is displayed with P0442, first perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0456.
● After repair, make sure that the hoses and clips are installed properly.
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait D
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Open engine hood before conducting following procedure. E
● If any of following conditions are met just before the DTC confirmation procedure, leave the vehi-
cle for more than 1 hour.
– Fuel filler cap is removed. F
– Fuel is refilled or drained.
– EVAP component parts is/are removed.
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle. G
PBIB0837E
WITH GST
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the EVAP very small leak function. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
CAUTION:
● Never use compressed air, doing so may damage the EVAP system.
● Do not start engine.
● Do not exceeded 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi).
1. Attach the EVAP service port adapter securely to the EVAP ser-
vice port.
PBIB2006E
SEF915U
Check that the cap is tightened properly by rotating the cap clockwise.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> 1. Open fuel filler cap, then clean cap and fuel filler neck threads using air blower.
2. Retighten until ratcheting sound is heard.
PBIB2006E
SEF916U
NOTE:
Improper installation of the EVAP service port adapter to the EVAP service port may cause leaking.
PEF917U
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak F
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details.
Refer to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING"
. G
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace. H
SEF200U
I
PBIB1611E
3. Pressurize the EVAP line using pressure pump with 1.3 to 2.7 kPa (10 to 20 mmHg, 0.39 to 0.79 inHg),
then remove pump and EVAP service port adapter.
NOTE:
● Never use compressed air or a high pressure pump.
Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in the system.
●
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details. Refer
to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF200U
PBIB1031E E
PBIB0147E
>> GO TO 20.
Check recirculation line between filler neck tube and fuel tank for clogging, kink, cracks, looseness and
improper connection. D
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 22.
NG >> Repair or replace hose, tube or filler neck tube. E
The fuel level sensor is mounted in the fuel level sensor unit. The
sensor detects a fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits a signal to
the “unified meter and A/C amp.”. The “unified meter and A/C amp.”
sends the fuel level sensor signal to the ECM through CAN commu-
nication line.
It consists of two parts, one is mechanical float and the other is vari-
able resistor. Fuel level sensor output voltage changes depending on
the movement of the fuel mechanical float.
PBIB1569E
NOTE:
If DTC P0460 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
When the vehicle is parked, naturally the fuel level in the fuel tank is stable. It means that output signal of the
fuel level sensor does not change. If ECM senses sloshing signal from the sensor, fuel level sensor malfunc-
tion is detected.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
Even though the vehicle is parked, a signal
P0460 Fuel level sensor circuit ● Harness or connectors
being varied is sent from the fuel level sensor
0460 noise
to ECM. (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● Fuel level sensor
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait maximum of 2 consecutive minutes.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-385, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF195Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
The fuel level sensor is mounted in the fuel level sensor unit. The
sensor detects a fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits a signal to
the “unified meter and A/C amp.”. The “unified meter and A/C amp.”
sends the fuel level sensor signal to the ECM through CAN commu-
nication line.
It consists of two parts, one is mechanical float and the other is vari-
able resistor. Fuel level sensor output voltage changes depending on
the movement of the fuel mechanical float.
PBIB1569E
NOTE:
If DTC P0461 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
Driving long distances naturally affect fuel gauge level.
This diagnosis detects the fuel gauge malfunction of the gauge not moving even after a long distance has
been driven.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
The output signal of the fuel level sensor does shorted)
P0461 Fuel level sensor circuit not change within the specified range even ● Harness or connectors
0461 range/performance though the vehicle has been driven a long dis-
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
tance.
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● Fuel level sensor
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the fuel level sensor function. During this check, a 1st trip
DTC might not be confirmed.
WARNING:
When performing following procedure, be sure to observe the handling of the fuel. Refer to FL-10,
"FUEL TANK" .
TESTING CONDITION:
Before starting overall function check, preparation of draining fuel and refilling fuel is required.
WITH CONSULT-II
NOTE:
Start from step 10, if it is possible to confirm that the fuel cannot be drained by 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/
8 Imp gal) in advance.
1. Prepare a fuel container and a spare hose.
2. Release fuel pressure from fuel line, refer to EC-51, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
3. Remove the fuel feed hose on the fuel level sensor unit.
4. Connect a spare fuel hose where the fuel feed hose was removed.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds then turn ON.
6. Select “FUEL LEVEL SE” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
WITH GST
NOTE: E
Start from step 8, if it is possible to confirm that the fuel cannot be drained by 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/8
Imp gal) in advance.
1. Prepare a fuel container and a spare hose.
F
2. Release fuel pressure from fuel line. Refer to EC-51, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
3. Remove the fuel feed hose on the fuel level sensor unit.
4. Connect a spare fuel hose where the fuel feed hose was removed. G
5. Turn ignition switch ON.
6. Drain fuel by 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/8 Imp gal) from the fuel tank using proper equipment.
7. Confirm that the fuel gauge indication varies. H
8. Fill fuel into the fuel tank for 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/8 Imp gal).
9. Confirm that the fuel gauge indication varies.
I
10. If NG, go to EC-387, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006S1
The fuel level sensor is mounted in the fuel level sensor unit. The
sensor detects a fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits a signal to
the “unified meter and A/C amp.”. The “unified meter and A/C amp.”
sends the fuel level sensor signal to the ECM through CAN commu-
nication line.
It consists of two parts, one is mechanical float and the other is vari-
able resistor. Fuel level sensor output voltage changes depending on
the movement of the fuel mechanical float.
PBIB1569E
NOTE:
If DTC P0462 or P0463 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for
DTC U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
This diagnosis indicates the former, to detect open or short circuit malfunction.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0462 Fuel level sensor circuit An excessively low voltage from the sensor is ● Harness or connectors
0462 low input sent to ECM. (The CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
● Harness or connectors
P0463 Fuel level sensor circuit An excessively high voltage from the sensor is (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
0463 high input sent to ECM.
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● Fuel level sensor
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at ignition
switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-389, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF195Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Description ABS006S9
NOTE:
If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the “unified meter and A/C amp.” from the “ABS actuator and electric unit
(control unit)” by CAN communication line. The “unified meter and A/C amp.” then sends a signal to the ECM
by CAN communication line.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006SA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 1 and 2 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine (TCS switch or VDC switch OFF).
2. Read “VHCL SPEED SE” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. The vehicle speed on CONSULT-
II should exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
If NG, go to EC-391, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Warm engine up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
ENG SPEED 1,700 - 6,000 rpm
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70°C (158°F)
B/FUEL SCHDL 4.9 - 31.8 msec
Selector lever Except P or N position
PW/ST SIGNAL OFF
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the vehicle speed sensor circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
1. CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”
D
Refer to BRC-12, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. E
NG >> Repair or replace.
Description ABS006SE
NOTE:
If DTC P0506 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for the other DTC.
The ECM controls the engine idle speed to a specified level through the fine adjustment of the air, which is let
into the intake manifold, by operating the electric throttle control actuator. The operating of the throttle valve is
varied to allow for optimum control of the engine idling speed. The crankshaft position sensor (POS) detects
the actual engine speed and sends a signal to the ECM.
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator so that the engine speed coincides with the target value
memorized in the ECM. The target engine speed is the lowest speed at which the engine can operate steadily.
The optimum value stored in the ECM is determined by taking into consideration various engine conditions,
such as during warming up, deceleration, and engine load (air conditioner, power steering and cooling fan
operation, etc.).
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006SF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
Idle speed control sys- ● Electric throttle control actuator
P0506 The idle speed is less than the target idle
tem RPM lower than
0506 speed by 100 rpm or more. ● Intake air leak
expected
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● If the target idle speed is out of the specified value, perform, EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" ,
before conducting DTC Confirmation Procedure. For the target idle speed, refer to the EC-660,
"SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)" .
TESTING CONDITION:
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
● Always perform the test at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Open engine hood.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON again and select “DATA MONITOR”
mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 1 minute at idle speed.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-393, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
2. REPLACE ECM
D
1. Stop engine.
2. Replace ECM.
3. Perform initialization of IVIS(NATS) system and registration of all IVIS(NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to E
BL-208, "ECM Re-communicating Function" .
4. Perform EC-49, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" . F
6. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Description ABS006SI
NOTE:
If DTC P0507 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for the other DTC.
The ECM controls the engine idle speed to a specified level through the fine adjustment of the air, which is let
into the intake manifold, by operating the electric throttle control actuator. The operating of the throttle valve is
varied to allow for optimum control of the engine idling speed. The crankshaft position sensor (POS) detects
the actual engine speed and sends a signal to the ECM.
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator so that the engine speed coincides with the target value
memorized in the ECM. The target engine speed is the lowest speed at which the engine can operate steadily.
The optimum value stored in the ECM is determined by taking into consideration various engine conditions,
such as during warming up, deceleration, and engine load (air conditioner, power steering and cooling fan
operation, etc.).
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006SJ
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● If the target idle speed is out of the specified value, perform, EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" ,
before conducting DTC Confirmation Procedure. For the target idle speed, refer to the EC-660,
"SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)" .
TESTING CONDITION:
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
● Always perform the test at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Open engine hood.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON again and select “DATA MONITOR”
mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 1 minute at idle speed.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-395, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
3. REPLACE ECM
F
1. Stop engine.
2. Replace ECM.
3. Perform initialization of IVIS(NATS) system and registration of all IVIS(NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to G
BL-208, "ECM Re-communicating Function" .
4. Perform EC-49, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" . H
6. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
I
>> INSPECTION END
PBIB1579E
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-398, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0302E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1579E
PBIB0188E H
4. CHECK PSP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
M
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 12 and PSP sensor terminal 2.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned. 0.5 - 4.5V
Steering wheel is not being turned. 0.4 - 0.8V
MBIB0126E
PBIB1164E
E
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006SU
FAIL-SAFE MODE H
ECM enters fail-safe mode when the malfunction A is detected.
Detected items Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
I
● ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5
degrees) by the return spring.
Malfunction A
● ECM deactivates ICC operation.
J
● ECM deactivates ASCD operation.
K
Perform “PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A” first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be confirmed, perform
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B. If there is no malfunction on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION
B, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
NOTE: L
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A M
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-402, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn
ON.
4. Repeat step 3 for 32 times.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-402, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006SW
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “SELF DIAG RESULTS” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch “ERASE”.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-401 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select MODE 4 with GST.
3. Touch “ERASE”.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-401 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
Battery voltage is supplied to the ECM even when the ignition switch
is turned OFF for the ECM memory function of the DTC memory, the
air-fuel ratio feedback compensation value memory, the idle air vol-
ume learning value memory, etc.
PBIB1164E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
P1065 ECM power supply cir- ECM back-up RAM system does not function [ECM power supply (back-up) circuit is
1065 cuit properly. open or shorted.]
● ECM
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn
ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for 4 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-406, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0250E
MBIB0026E
5. REPLACE ECM
H
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of IVIS(NATS) system and registration of all IVIS(NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to
BL-208, "ECM Re-communicating Function" .
I
3. Perform EC-49, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" . J
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1111
1111 ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) An improper voltage is sent to the ECM (Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
Intake valve timing control
through intake valve timing control solenoid circuit is open or shorted.)
P1136 solenoid valve circuit
valve.
1136 ● Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
(Bank 2)
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-412, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Following the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0281E
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
11 BR [Engine is running]
solenoid valve (bank 1)
● Warm-up condition
● When revving engine up to 2,500 rpm
quickly
PBIB1790E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
EC
TBWM0282E
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
10 OR [Engine is running]
solenoid valve (bank 2)
● Warm-up condition
● When revving engine up to 2,500 rpm
quickly
PBIB1790E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
1. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
PBIB1562E
PBIB0192E
3. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR D
OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. E
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 11 (bank 1) or 10 (bank 2) and intake valve timing con-
trol solenoid valve terminal 1. Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power. G
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4. H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0193E
Electric throttle control actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve. EC
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve position, and the opening and closing speed of the throt-
tle valve and feeds the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle
valve from these signals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening
angle properly in response to driving condition. C
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
Electric throttle control actuator does not func- E
A) tion properly due to the return spring malfunc-
tion.
P1121 Electric throttle control
● Electric throttle control actuator
1121 actuator Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
B) F
not in specified range.
C) ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.
G
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode H
The ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the idle position.
Malfunction A
The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
Malfunction B ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20 degrees or less. I
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the engine stalls.
Malfunction C
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or more.
J
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS006TC
NOTE:
● Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B first. If the DTC cannot be confirmed, perform K
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test. L
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second. M
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position and wait at least 3 seconds.
4. Shift selector lever to P position.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
7. Shift selector lever to D position, and wait at least 3 seconds.
8. Shift selector lever to P position.
9. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn
ON.
SEF058Y
10. If DTC is detected, go to EC-416, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006TD
PBIB1556E
NOTE:
If DTC P1122 is displayed with DTC P1121 or 1126, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1121 or EC
P1126. Refer to EC-415 or EC-423 .
Electric throttle control actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed- C
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
D
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006TF
● Harness or connectors
P1122 Electric throttle control Electric throttle control function does not oper- (Throttle control motor circuit is open or
1122 performance problem ate properly. shorted) F
● Electric throttle control actuator
FAIL-SAFE MODE G
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
H
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0369E
0 - 14V D
[Ignition switch: ON]
Throttle control motor ● Engine stopped
4 L/W E
(Close) ● Shift lever: D
● Accelerator pedal: Released
PBIB1104E F
0 - 14V
BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Ignition switch: OFF] I
104 L/OR Throttle control motor relay (11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch: ON] 0 - 1.0V
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1171E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
8. CHECK FUSE
1. Disconnect 15A fuse. H
2. Check 15A fuse for blown.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9. I
NG >> Replace 15A fuse.
PBIB1556E
PBIB0095E
Power supply for the throttle control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends EC
an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
provided to the ECM.
C
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006TM
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at L
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1124
M
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If DTC is detected, go to EC-426, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0304E
PBIB1171E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006TS
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-430, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0305E
0 - 14V
PBIB1104E
0 - 14V
PBIB1105E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB0095E
SEF463R
H
SEF288D
SEF300U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1143 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
1143 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
(Bank 1) The maximum and minimum voltage from the
Heated oxygen sensor
sensor are not reached to the specified volt- ● Fuel pressure
P1163 1 lean shift monitoring
ages. ● Injector
1163
(Bank 2) ● Intake air leaks
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Always perform at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
● Before performing following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “HO2S1 (B1) P1143” of “HO2S1” or “HO2S1 (B2) P1163” of “HO2S1”
in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch “START”.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
PBIB0546E
step 2.
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG
RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-435, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
SEC769C
A
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST EC
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1(B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and
ground. C
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
– The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least 1 time. D
– The minimum voltage is over 0.1V at least 1 time.
4. If NG, go to EC-435, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
E
F
PBIB1107E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
L
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1577E
>> GO TO 3.
Revision: 2004 November EC-435 2004 FX35/FX45
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1
[VQ35DE]
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching “CLEAR”.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
SEF968Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected? PBIB1565E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or P0174. Refer to EC-256 .
No >> GO TO 4.
SEF646Y
J
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m
(19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor
Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
SEF463R
H
SEF288D
SEF299U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1144
1144 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor The maximum and minimum voltages from the ● Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
P1164 1 rich shift monitoring sensor are beyond the specified voltages. ● Fuel pressure
1164 ● Injector
(Bank 2)
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Always perform at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “HO2S1 (B1) P1144” or “HO2S1 (B2) P1164” of “HO2S1” in “DTC
WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch “START”.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
PBIB0548E
step 2.
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG
RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-441, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
SEC772C
A
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST EC
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1(B1) signal] 16 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm C
constant under no load.
– The maximum voltage is below 0.8V at least 1 time.
– The minimum voltage is below 0.35V at least 1 time. D
4. If NG, go to EC-441, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1107E F
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006UB
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. L
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1577E
>> GO TO 3.
SEF968Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected? PBIB1565E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172 or P0175. Refer to EC-265 .
No >> GO TO 4.
PBIB1559E
E
3. Check connectors for water.
Water should not exist. F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors. G
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m
(19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor
Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 16 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst 1, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
SEF327R
SEF972Z
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1146 ● Harness or connectors
1146 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor
The minimum voltage from the sensor is not ● Heated oxygen sensor 2
2 minimum voltage
P1166 reached to the specified voltage.
monitoring ● Fuel pressure
1166
(Bank 2) ● Fuel injector
A
NOTE:
If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
For better results, perform DTC WORK SUPPORT at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
C
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera- D
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and E
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C F
(158°F). SEF174Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
G
7. Open engine hood.
8. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P1146” or “HO2S2 (B2) P1166” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
H
9. Start engine and following the instruction of CONSULT-II.
PBIB0818E
10. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”. L
If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-452, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If “CAN NOT BE DIAGNOSED” is displayed, perform the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
M
b. Return to step 1.
Overall Function Check ABS006UI
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0292E
EC
TBWM0293E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
E
SEF968Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. F
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
G
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
H
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
I
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected? PBIB1565E
J
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-265 .
K
No >> GO TO 3.
SEF174Y
EC
SEF662Y
D
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.
PBIB0796E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.63V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%. H
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 I
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant. J
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. K
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
L
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
6. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times. M
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.63V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.63V at step 6, step 7 is not neces-
sary.
7. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with “OD” OFF.
The voltage should be below 0.48V at least once during this PBIB1607E
procedure.
8. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst 1, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank. EC
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt- C
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for D
engine control operation.
SEF327R
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006UO
PBIB0820E
L
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1147 ● Harness or connectors
M
1147 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor ● Heated oxygen sensor 2
The maximum voltage from the sensor is not
2 maximum voltage
P1167 reached to the specified voltage. ● Fuel pressure
monitoring
1167 ● Fuel injector
(Bank 2)
● Intake air leaks
NOTE:
If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
For better results, perform DTC WORK SUPPORT at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C
(158°F). SEF174Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
7. Open engine hood.
8. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P1147” or “HO2S2 (B2) P1167” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
9. Start engine and following the instruction of CONSULT-II.
PBIB0819E
10. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”.
If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-463, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If “CAN NOT BE DIAGNOSED” is displayed, perform the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
b. Return to step 1.
Overall Function Check ABS006UR
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
BANK 1
TBWM0292E
TBWM0293E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. L
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
SEF968Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-67, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected? PBIB1565E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171or P0174. Refer to EC-256 .
No >> GO TO 3.
SEF174Y
SEF662Y
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.
PBIB0796E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.63V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 74 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 55 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
6. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.63V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.63V at step 6, step 7 is not neces-
sary.
7. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with “OD” OFF.
The voltage should be below 0.48V at least once during this PBIB1607E
procedure.
8. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
EC
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm during the DTC Confirmation Procedure. If the engine
speed limit is exceeded, retry the procedure from step 2.
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm and check one of the following.
– “HO2S1 (B1)/(B2)” voltage should go above 0.70V at least once.
– “HO2S1 (B1)/(B2)” voltage should go below 0.21V at least once.
If the check result is NG, perform EC-469, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
If the check result is OK, perform the following step.
4. Let engine idle at least 5 minutes.
5. Maintain the following condition at least 50 consecutive sec-
onds. SEC011C
During this test, P0132 and/or P0152 may be displayed on CONSULT-II screen.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-469, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check ABS006UY
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the closed loop control. During this check, a DTC might not
be confirmed.
D
PBIB1107E
Description ABS006V0
The malfunction information related to TCS is transferred through the CAN communication line from “ABS
actuator and electric unit (control unit)” to ECM.
Be sure to erase the malfunction information such as DTC not only for “ABS actuator and electric unit
(control unit)” but also for ECM after TCS related repair.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006V1
Freeze frame data is not stored in the ECM for this self-diagnosis. The MIL will not light up for this self-
diagnosis.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● ABS actuator and electric unit (control
P1211 ECM receives a malfunction information from unit)
TCS control unit
1211 “ABS actuator and electric unit (Control unit)”.
● TCS related parts
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 60 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-470, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006V3
NOTE:
If DTC P1212 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000, EC
U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
This CAN communication line is used to control the smooth engine operation during the TCS operation. Pulse
signals are exchanged between ECM and “ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)”.
Be sure to erase the malfunction information such as DTC not only for “ABS actuator and electric unit C
(control unit)” but also for ECM after TCS related repair.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006V5
D
Freeze frame data is not stored in the ECM for this self-diagnosis. The MIL will not light up for this self-
diagnosis.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
E
● Harness or connectors
ECM can not receive the information (The CAN communication line is open or
P1212 TCS communication
from “ABS actuator and electric unit (con- shorted.) F
1212 line
trol unit)”. ● ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
● Dead (Weak) battery
G
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS006V6
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V at idle. H
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
I
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 10 seconds.
4. If a 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-471, "Diagnostic Proce- J
dure" .
L
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above. M
Description ABS00DAP
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
Cooling Fan Control
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Engine speed*1
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant
pressure, and air conditioner ON signal. The control system has 4-step control [HIGH/MIDDLE/LOW/OFF].
EC
PBIB2023E
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Cooling Fan Motor
The cooling fan operates at each speed when the current flows in the cooling fan motor as follows.
Cooling fan motor terminals
Cooling fan speed
(+) (−)
1 3 and 4
2 3 and 4
Middle (MID)
1 and 2 3
1 and 2 4
High (HI) 1 and 2 3 and 4
The cooling fan operates at low (LOW) speed when cooling fan motors-1 and -2 are circuited in series under
middle speed condition.
A
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF EC
● Engine: After warming up, idle
AIR COND SIG Air conditioner switch: ON
the engine ON
(Compressor operates.)
Engine coolant temperature is 94°C C
OFF
(201°F) or less
Engine coolant temperature is
between 95°C (203°F) and 99°C LOW D
● Engine: After warming up, idle
(210°F)
COOLING FAN the engine
Engine coolant temperature is
● Air conditioner switch: OFF
between 100°C (212°F) and 104°C MID
(219°F)
E
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
rise. G
When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction is
indicated.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic. H
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The cooling fan circuit is open or I
shorted.)
● Cooling fan does not operate properly (Over-
● IPDM E/R
heat).
● Cooling fan J
● Cooling fan system does not operate prop-
P1217 Engine over tempera- erly (Overheat). ● Radiator hose
1217 ture (Overheat) ● Engine coolant level was not added to the ● Radiator
system using the proper filling method. ● Radiator cap
K
● Engine coolant is not within the specified ● Water pump
range.
● Thermostat
L
For more information, refer to EC-484,
"Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
CAUTION: M
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to CO-11, "Changing Engine
Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil. Refer to LU-9, "Changing Engine Oil" .
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-13, "Anti-Freeze Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check ABS006VB
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
SEF621W
SEF646X
WITH GST
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-479,
"PROCEDURE A" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-479,
"PROCEDURE A" .
SEF621W
3. Perform IPDM E/R auto active test and check cooling fan motors operation, refer to PG-24, "Auto Active
Test"
4. If NG, go to EC-479, "PROCEDURE A" .
EC
TBWM0306E
TBWM0307E
PROCEDURE A A
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II? EC
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3. C
SEF784Z
H
● Hose
● Radiator
● Water pump
SLC755A
6. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
2. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
Valve opening temperature: 76.5°C (170°F) [standard]
Valve lift: More than 8.6 mm/90°C
(0.339 in/194°F)
3. Check if valve is closed at 5°C (9°F) below valve opening tem-
perature.
For details, refer to CO-26, "WATER INLET AND THERMO-
STAT ASSEMBLY" .
OK or NG
SLC343
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace thermostat
PBIB1666E
PBIB1554E
PBIB1670E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
ON*2 6 ● Thermostat ● Touch the upper and Both hoses should be hot CO-26
lower radiator hoses
H
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: I
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
J
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
K
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-486, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. L
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
PBIB1556E
H
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: I
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
J
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
K
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for 32 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-488, "Diagnostic Procedure" L
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
PBIB1556E
FAIL-SAFE MODE
G
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return H
spring.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0402E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. L
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1580E
PBIB0914E
4. CHECK COMPONENTS
Check the following.
● Refrigerant pressure sensor (Refer to ATC-90, "COMPONENT INSPECTION" .)
● Power steering pressure sensor (Refer to EC-400, "Component Inspection" .)
● EVAP control system pressure sensor (Refer to EC-351, "Component Inspection" .)
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning component.
G
>> INSPECTION END
Description ABS006VU
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Engine speed*1
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
SEF337U
A
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● EVAP canister purge volume control EC
solenoid valve
The canister purge flow is detected during the (The valve is stuck open.)
EVAP canister purge
P1444 specified driving conditions, even when EVAP
volume control solenoid ● EVAP canister vent control valve C
1444 canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
valve ● EVAP canister
completely closed.
● Hoses
(Hoses are connected incorrectly or D
clogged.)
L
PBIB0839E
6. Start engine and let it idle until “TESTING” on CONSULT-II changes to “COMPLETED”. (It will take
approximately 10 seconds.) M
If “TESTING” is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2.
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-
498, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 20 seconds.
4. Select MODE 7 with GST.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-498, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
TBWM0300E
SEC990C
EVAP canister purge vol-
45 GY
ume control solenoid valve BATTERY VOLTAGE F
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G
● Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
H
SEC991C
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch: OFF] I
0 - 1.5V
● For a few seconds after turning ignition
ECM relay switch OFF
111 W/B
(Self shut-off)
[Ignition switch: OFF] J
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● More than a few seconds after turning igni- (11 - 14V)
tion switch OFF
119 R BATTERY VOLTAGE K
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch: ON]
120 R (11 - 14V)
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
L
1. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB2006E
PBIB0148E
3. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 45 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
K
PBIB0147E
PBIB1031E
PBIB0149E
E
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions. F
Air passage continuity
Condition
between A and B
12V direct current supply between G
Yes
terminals 1 and 2
No supply No
H
PBIB0150E
The EVAP canister vent control valve is located on the EVAP canis-
ter and is used to seal the canister vent.
This solenoid valve responds to signals from the ECM. When the
ECM sends an ON signal, the coil in the solenoid valve is energized.
A plunger will then move to seal the canister vent. The ability to seal
the vent is necessary for the on board diagnosis of other evaporative
emission control system components.
This solenoid valve is used only for diagnosis, and usually remains
opened.
When the vent is closed, under normal purge conditions, the evapo-
rative emission control system is depressurized and allows EVAP
PBIB1263E
Control System diagnosis.
PBIB1611E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● EVAP canister vent control valve
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
P1446 EVAP canister vent con- EVAP canister vent control valve remains and the circuit
1446 trol valve close closed under specified driving conditions. ● Blocked rubber tube to EVAP canister
vent control valve
● EVAP canister is saturated with water
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. C
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and let it idle for at least 1 minute. D
5. Repeat next procedures 3 times.
a. Increase the engine speed up to 3,000 to 3,500 rpm and keep it
for 2 minutes and 50 seconds to 3 minutes. E
Never exceed 3 minutes.
b. Fully released accelerator pedal and keep engine idle for about
5 seconds. F
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-505, "Diagnostic Procedure" SEF058Y
.
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to the next step.
G
7. Repeat next procedure 20 times.
a. Quickly increase the engine speed up to 4,000 to 4,500 rpm or more and keep it for 25 to 30 seconds.
b. Fully released accelerator pedal and keep engine idle for at least 35 seconds. H
K
PBIB0972E
TBWH0110E
H
PBIB1611E
PBIB1031E
PBIB1033E
D
7. Clean the air passage (Portion A to B ) of EVAP canister vent control valve using an air blower.
8. Perform step 6 again.
Without CONSULT-II E
1. Remove EVAP canister vent control valve from EVAP canister.
2. Check portion B of EVAP canister vent control valve for being
rusted. F
PBIB1033E
I
3. Check air passage continuity and operation delay time under the
following conditions.
Make sure new O-ring is installed properly.
J
Condition Air passage continuity between A and B
12V direct current supply between
No
terminals 1 and 2 K
OFF Yes
Operation takes less than 1 second.
L
If NG, replace EVAP canister vent control valve. PBIB1034E
PBIB1540E
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TBWM0273E
M
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
Pressed ON
ACCEL/RESUME switch RESUME/ACC SW
Released OFF
Pressed ON
DISTANCE switch DIST SW
Released OFF
Pressed ON
CANCEL switch CANCEL SW
Released OFF
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 99 and ground with press-
ing each button.
Switch Condition Voltage [V]
Pressed Approx. 0
ON/OFF(MAIN) switch
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 3.0
COAST/SET switch
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 3.7
ACCEL/ RESUME switch PBIB0311E
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 2.2
DISTANCE switch
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 1.3
CANCEL switch
Released Approx. 4.3
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 3.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ICC STEERING SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT H
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 99 and combination switch terminal 14.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. I
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power. J
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6. K
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following. L
● Combination switch (spiral cable)
● Harness for open and short between ECM and combination switch
M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1513E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006WA
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Press ON/OFF(MAIN) switch for at least 10 seconds, then
release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Press ACCEL/RESUME switch for at least 10 seconds, then
release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Press COAST/SET switch for at least 10 seconds, then release
it and wait at least 10 seconds.
7. Press CANCEL switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it
and wait at least 10 seconds. SEF058Y
EC
TBWM0257E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
Without CONSULT-II G
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 99 and ground with press- H
ing each button.
Switch Condition Voltage [V]
Pressed Approx. 0 I
ON/OFF(MAIN) switch
Released Approx. 4
Pressed Approx. 2
COAST/SET switch J
Released Approx. 4
Pressed Approx. 3
ACCEL/RESUME switch PBIB0311E
Released Approx. 4 K
Pressed Approx. 1
CANCEL switch
Released Approx. 4
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 3.
M
3. CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect combination switch harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between combination switch terminal
15 and ECM terminal 82. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4. PBIB1513E
5. CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 99 and combination switch terminal 14.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
NOTE:
● If DTC P1568 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC EC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
● If DTC P1568 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605.
Refer to EC-401 C
● This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
● The MIL will not light up for this self-diagnosis.
Trouble Diagnosis D
DTC No. DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
Name
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or E
P1568 ECM detects a difference between signals shorted.)
ICC function
1568 from ICC unit is out of specified range.
● ICC unit
● ECM F
CAUTION: G
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait H
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● Step 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road
test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
I
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. J
3. Press ON/OFF(MAIN) switch on ICC steering switch.
4. Drive the vehicle at more than 40 km/h (25 MPH).
5. Press COAST/SET switch. K
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-521, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
L
SEF058Y
M
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006WI
When the brake pedal is depressed, ICC brake switch is turned OFF
and stop lamp switch is turned ON. ECM detects the state of the
brake pedal by this input of two kinds (ON/OFF signal).
Refer to ACS-6, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
PBIB1539E
NOTE:
This diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
The MIL will not light up for this self-diagnosis.
● If DTC P1572 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605.
Refer to EC-401 .
● This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic. When malfunction A is detected, DTC is not
stored in ECM memory. And in that case, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip freeze frame data are displayed.
1st trip DTC is erased when ignition switch OFF. And even when malfunction A is detected in two
consecutive trips, DTC is not stored in ECM memory.
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
● ON signals from the stop lamp switch and ● Harness or connectors
A) the ICC brake switch are sent to ECM at (The stop lamp switch circuit is open or
the same time. shorted.)
● Harness or connectors
(The ICC brake switch circuit is open or
shorted.)
P1572
ICC brake switch ● Stop lamp switch
1572 ● ICC brake switch signal is not sent to ECM
B) for extremely long time while the vehicle is ● ICC brake switch
driving. ● ICC brake hold relay
● Incorrect stop lamp switch installation
● Incorrect ICC brake switch installation
● ECM
A
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait EC
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● Procedure for malfunction B is not described here. It takes extremely long time to complete procedure for
malfunction B. By performing procedure for malfunction A, the incident that causes malfunction B can be C
detected.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 3 and 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a D
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine. E
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Press MAIN switch and make sure that CRUISE indicator lights
up. F
4. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the
following condition.
G
VHCL SPEED SE More than 30 km/h (19 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
H
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-525, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. PBIB2386E
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to the following step.
5. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the following condition. I
TBWM0274E
SEC011D
K
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch “ON”.
L
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE M
When brake pedal is depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
MBIB0061E
SEC013D
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is released Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is depressed Battery voltage
PBIB1537E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> GO TO 12.
PBIB1531E
E
4. Check voltage between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9. G
NG >> GO TO 5.
H
PBIB1538E
PBIB1539E M
PBIB0857E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch “OFF”.
2. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and ICC brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch “OFF”.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 4 and ECM terminal 108.
Refer Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ICC brake hold relay.
PBIB1539E
E
3. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT -II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14. G
NG >> GO TO 13.
H
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
14. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector. M
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 15.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
SEC023D
PBIB1185E
PBIB1605E
A
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait EC
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● Procedure for malfunction B is not described here. It takes extremely long time to complete procedure for
malfunction B. By performing procedure for malfunction A, the incident that causes malfunction B can be C
detected.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 3 and 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a D
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine (TCS switch or VDC switch OFF). E
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Press MAIN switch and make sure that CRUISE indicator lights
up. F
4. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the
following conditions.
G
VHCL SPEED SE More than 30 km/h (19 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
H
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-535, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. PBIB2386E
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to the following step.
5. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the following conditions. I
TBWM0258E
CONDITION INDICATION
When brake pedal is slightly depressed OFF I
When brake pedal is fully released ON
K
SEC011D
Without CONSULT-II
L
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
M
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
MBIB0061E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
SEC013D
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is fully released Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Battery voltage
MBIB0060E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 8.
PBIB1605E
E
4. Check voltage between ASCD brake switch terminal 1 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5. G
NG >> GO TO 4.
H
PBIB0857E
5. CHECK ASCD BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT L
PBIB1605E
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
G
>> INSPECTION END
SEC023D
PBIB1185E
The ECM receives two vehicle speed signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from “unified meter and
A/C amp.”, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). The ECM uses these signals for ICC EC
control. Refer to ACS-6, "DESCRIPTION" for ICC functions.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS007ZE
C
● This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
● The MIL will not light up for this self-diagnosis.
NOTE: D
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0500, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0500.
E
Refer to EC-390 .
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605.
Refer to EC-401 .
F
Trouble Diagnosis
DTC No. DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
Name
● Harness or connectors G
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
P1574 ICC vehicle speed ECM detects a difference between two vehicle H
1574 sensor speed signals is out of the specified range. ● ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
● Wheel sensor
● TCM
I
● ECM
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
2. CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”
Refer to BRC-12, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
The ECM receives two vehicle speed sensor signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from “unified
meter and A/C amp.”, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). The ECM uses these signals EC
for ASCD control. Refer to EC-657, "AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)" for ASCD functions.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS006WR
C
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
The MIL will not light up for this diagnosis.
NOTE:
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC D
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-142 .
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0500, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0500.
Refer to EC-390 E
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605.
Refer to EC-401
F
Trouble Diagnosis
DTC No. DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
Name
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or G
shorted.)
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
P1574 ASCD vehicle speed ECM detects a difference between two vehicle
● ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
H
1574 sensor speed signals is out of the specified range.
● Wheel sensor
● TCM
I
● ECM
J
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at K
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Step 3 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road test L
is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine. M
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Drive the vehicle at more than 40 km/h (25 MPH).
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-544, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
2. CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”
Refer to BRC-12, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
[The park/neutral position (PNP) switch
The signal of the park/neutral position (PNP) circuit is open or shorted.]
F
P1706 Park/neutral position
switch is not changed in the process of engine ● Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
1706 switch
starting and driving.
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
G
● TCM
H
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at I
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
J
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “P/N POSI SW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CON-
SULT-II. Then check the “P/N POSI SW” signal under the follow-
K
ing conditions.
Position (Selector lever) Known-good signal
P or N position ON L
Except above position OFF
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the park/neutral position (PNP) switch circuit. During this
check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 102 (PNP switch signal)
and ground under the following conditions.
Condition (Gear position) Voltage V (Known-good data)
P or N position Approx. 0
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Except above position
(11 - 14V)
3. If NG, go to EC-548, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0043E
EC
TBWM0521E
3. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect A/T assembly harness connector.
3. Disconnect “unified meter and A/C amp.” harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between A/T assembly terminal 9 and “unified meter and A/C amp.” terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-III
1. Check harness continuity between A/T assembly terminal 9 and TCM terminal 8. E
Refer to AT-108, "DTC P0615 START SIGNAL CIRCUIT" .
Continuity should exist.
F
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7. G
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Description ABS006X1
Brake switch signal is applied to the ECM through the stop lamp switch when the brake pedal is depressed.
This signal is used mainly to decrease the engine speed when the vehicle is driving.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006X2
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to a small range.
Therefore, acceleration will be poor.
Vehicle condition Driving condition
When engine is idling Normal
When accelerating Poor acceleration
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the DTC with CONSULT-II.
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-552, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0260E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
PBIB1605E
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT D
PBIB1605E
PBIB1185E
3. If NG, adjust stop lamp switch installation, refer to BR-6, "BRAKE PEDAL" , and perform step 2 again.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-558, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0239E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1580E
PBIB0914E H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-3, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" . C
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-565, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0506E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1580E
PBIB0915E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
10. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 98 and APP sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-3, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
FAIL-SAFE MODE L
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
M
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-572, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0427E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1557E
PBIB0082E H
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 5 and ECM terminal 66.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 50 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4, ECM
terminal 69 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next PBIB1608E
F
step.
7. Perform EC-49, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-49, "Idle Air Volume Learning" . G
Removal and Installation ABS00CIA
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-579, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0507E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1580E
PBIB0914E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Voltage: Approximately 5V
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 5.
PBIB0915E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
13. CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 5, ECM terminal 98 and
APP sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 14.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
C
>> INSPECTION END
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-3, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
PBIB1560E
F
TBWM0261E
TBWM0308E
SEC987C
H
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
TBWM0309E
SEC987C
H
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
I
1. CHECK ENGINE START
Turn ignition switch OFF, and restart engine.
Is engine running? J
Yes or No
Yes (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
Yes (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3. K
No >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0133E
PBIB1186E
SEC986C
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 10.
MBIB0034E
PBIB1606E
E
4. Check voltage between condenser terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Battery voltage F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7. G
NG >> GO TO 6.
H
PBIB0624E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK CONDENSER
Refer to EC-595, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace condenser.
PBIB1560E
PBIB0138E
14. CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT G
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
M
16. CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EC-595, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ignition coil with power transistor.
PBIB0847E
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check resistance between condenser terminals 1 and 2.
Resistance Above 1 MΩ at 25°C (77°F)
PBIB0794E
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
supplies a ground to the injector circuit, the coil in the injector is EC
energized. The energized coil pulls the ball valve back and allows
fuel to flow through the injector into the intake manifold. The amount
of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse
duration is the length of time the injector remains open. The ECM C
controls the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
SEF375Z
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006YA
TBWM0310E
H
SEC985C
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
I
Diagnostic Procedure ABS006YC
1. INSPECTION START
J
Turn ignition switch to START.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes or No K
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
L
PBIB0133E
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
PBIB1986E
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB1561E
E
4. Check voltage between injector terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Battery voltage F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5. G
NG >> GO TO 4.
H
PBIB0582E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK INJECTOR
Refer to EC-602, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace injector.
INJECTOR
1. Disconnect injector harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals as shown in the figure.
Resistance: 13.5 - 17.5Ω [at 10 - 60°C (50 - 140°F)]
PBIB1727E
INJECTOR
Refer to EM-45, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator EC
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed*
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
Battery Battery voltage* C
*: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM activates the fuel pump for several seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON to improve engine
D
start ability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the camshaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows
that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the engine speed signal is not received when
the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump operation and prevents battery discharging,
thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump E
relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.
Condition Fuel pump operation
Ignition switch is turned to ON. Operates for 1 second. F
Engine running and cranking Operates.
When engine is stopped Stops in 1.5 seconds.
G
Except as shown above Stops.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
H
A turbine type design fuel pump is used in the fuel tank.
K
PBIB1569E
TBWH0112E
PBIB1612E
PBIB1187E
PBIB1926E
11. CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
M
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” harness con-
nector.
3. Disconnect harness connector E206, B6.
4. Check harness continuity between “fuel level sensor unit and
fuel pump” terminal 1 and harness connector B6 terminal 4, “fuel
level sensor unit and fuel pump” terminal 3 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
PBIB1572E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 12.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
FUEL PUMP
1. Disconnect “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” harness connector.
2. Check resistance between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
terminals 1 and 3.
Resistance: Approximately 0.2 - 5.0Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]
SEC918C
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check resistance between condenser terminals as 1 and 2.
Resistance Above 1 MΩ at 25°C (77°F)
PBIB0794E
FUEL PUMP
Refer to FL-4, "FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY" .
PBIB2007E
H
PBIB2657E
TBWM0312E
K
PBIB1188E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB2007E
PBIB0188E
5. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
F
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Description ABS006YP
The electrical load signal (Headlamp switch signal, etc.) is transferred through the CAN communication line
from BCM to ECM via IPDM E/R.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006YQ
PBIB0103E
When the brake pedal is depressed, ICC brake switch is turned OFF
and stop lamp switch is turned ON. ECM detects the state of the EC
brake pedal by this input of two kinds (ON/OFF signal)
Refer to ACS-6, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
C
PBIB1539E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006YT
TBWM0275E
SEC011D
K
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch “ON”.
L
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE M
When brake pedal is depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
MBIB0061E
SEC013D
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is released Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is depressed Battery voltage
PBIB1537E
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 12.
PBIB1531E
E
4. Check voltage between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9. G
NG >> GO TO 5.
H
PBIB1538E
PBIB1539E M
PBIB0857E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch “OFF”.
2. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and ICC brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch “OFF”.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 4 and ECM terminal 108.
Refer Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ICC brake fold relay.
PBIB1539E
E
3. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT -II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14. G
NG >> GO TO 13.
H
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
14. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector. M
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 15.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
SEC023D
PBIB1185E
PBIB1089E
EC
TBWM0266E
SEC011D
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
MBIB0061E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
SEC013D E
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the following conditions. F
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is fully released Approximately 0V
G
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Battery voltage
I
MBIB0060E
OK or NG J
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 8.
K
PBIB1605E
PBIB0857E
5. CHECK ASCD BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 108 and ASCD brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
PBIB1605E
G
PBIB1184E
K
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
● Fuse block (J/B) connector E201 L
● 10A fuse
● Joint connector-2
M
● Harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
E
SEC023D
PBIB1185E
ASCD indicator lamp illuminates to indicate ASCD operation status. Lamp has two indicators, CRUISE and
SET, and is integrated in combination meter.
CRUISE indicator illuminates when ON/OFF(MAIN) switch on ASCD steering switch is turned ON to indicated
that ASCD system is ready for operation.
SET indicator illuminates when following conditions are met.
● CRUISE indicator is illuminated.
● SET switch on ASCD steering switch is turned ON while vehicle speed is within the range of ASCD set-
ting.
SET indicator remains lit during ASCD control.
Refer to EC-657, "AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)" for the ASCD function.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS006Z3
EC
TBWM0267E
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK DTC
Check that DTC U1000 or U1001 is not displayed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnoses for DTC U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-142, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN
COMMUNICATION LINE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 are displayed, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000, U1001. EC
Refer to EC-142, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The snow mode switch signal is sent to the “unified meter and A/C amp.” from the snow mode switch. The
“unified meter and A/C amp.” then sends the signal to the ECM by CAN communication line.
The snow mode is used for driving or starting the vehicle on snowy roads or slippery areas. If the snow mode C
is activated, the vehicle speed will not be accelerated immediately than your original pedal in due to avoid the
vehicle slip. In other words, ECM controls the rapid engine torque change by controlling the electric throttle
control actuator operating speed. D
CONSULT-II Reference Value in the Data Monitor Mode ABS00A2C
TBWH0217E
CONDITION INDICATION
Snow mode switch: ON ON D
Snow mode switch: OFF OFF
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. PBIB2009E
E
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB2011E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK SNOW MODE SWITCH OUT PUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between snow mode switch terminal 3 and “unified meter and A/C amp.” termi-
nal 12. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK SNOW MODE INDICATOR LAMP GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT E
1. Check harness continuity between snow mode switch terminal 6 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
F
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG G
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
H
10. CHECK SNOW MODE INDICATOR LAMP
Check harness continuity between snow mode switch terminals 5 and 6 under the following conditions.
I
L
PBIB2082E
Condition Continuity
M
1 Should exist.
2 Should not exist.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace snow mode switch.
PBIB2012E
EC
TBWM0268E
TBWM0269E
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
EC
G
PBIB1631E
The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel H
system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank. I
The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
proportionally regulated as the air flow increases. J
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
idling.
K
PBIB2008E
EC
PBIB2295E
EVAP CANISTER
Check EVAP canister as follows:
1. Block port B .
2. Blow air into port A and check that it flows freely out of port C .
3. Release blocked port B .
4. Apply vacuum pressure to port B and check that vacuum pres-
sure exists at the ports A and C .
5. Block port A and B .
6. Apply pressure to port C and check that there is no leakage.
PBIB1044E
FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FULLER CAP)
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
SEF445Y
SEF462UA
D
EVAP CANISTER E
Tighten EVAP canister as shown in the figure.
K
PBIB1029E
PBIB1030E
CAUTION:
● Never use compressed air or a high pressure pump.
● Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in EVAP system.
NOTE:
● Do not start engine.
● Improper installation of EVAP service port adapter to the EVAP service port may cause a leak.
PEF838U
PEF917U
SEF200U
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Attach the EVAP service port adapter securely to the EVAP ser-
vice port.
2. Also attach the pressure pump with pressure gauge to the EVAP
service port adapter.
SEF462UA
EC
D
PBIB1611E
4. To locate the leak, deliver positive pressure to the EVAP system until pressure gauge points reach 1.38 to
2.76 kPa (0.014 to 0.028 kg/cm2 , 0.2 to 0.4 psi). E
5. Remove EVAP service port adapter and hose with pressure pump.
6. Locate the leak using a leak detector. Refer to EC-644, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
F
PBIB1068E
From the beginning of refueling, the air and vapor inside the fuel tank go through refueling EVAP vapor cut
valve and EVAP/ORVR line to the EVAP canister. The vapor is absorbed by the EVAP canister and the air is
released to the atmosphere.
When the refueling has reached the full level of the fuel tank, the refueling EVAP vapor cut valve is closed and
refueling is stopped because of auto shut-off. The vapor which was absorbed by the EVAP canister is purged
during driving.
WARNING:
When conducting inspections below, be sure to observe the following:
● Put a “CAUTION: INFLAMMABLE” sign in workshop.
● Do not smoke while servicing fuel system. Keep open flames and sparks away from work area.
● Be sure to furnish the workshop with a CO2 fire extinguisher.
CAUTION:
● Before removing fuel line parts, carry out the following procedures:
– Put drained fuel in an explosion-proof container and put lid on securely.
– Release fuel pressure from fuel line. Refer to Fuel Pressure Release, EC-51 .
– Disconnect battery ground cable.
● Always replace O-ring when the fuel gauge retainer is removed.
● Do not kink or twist hose and tube when they are installed.
● Do not tighten hose and clamps excessively to avoid damaging hoses.
● After installation, run engine and check for fuel leaks at connection.
● Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off automatically.
Continued refueling may cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel spray and possibly a fire.
H
PBIB1031E
L
>> Repair or replace EVAP hose.
PBIB1031E
>> GO TO 4.
SEF665U
PBIB1035E
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel tank. Refer to FL-10, "FUEL TANK" .
2. Drain fuel from the tank as follows:
a. Remove fuel gauge retainer.
b. Drain fuel from the tank using a handy pump into a fuel container.
3. Check refueling EVAP vapor cut valve for being stuck to close as follows.
Blow air into the refueling EVAP vapor cut valve (from the end of EVAP/ORVR line hose), and check that
the air flows freely into the tank.
4. Check refueling EVAP vapor cut valve for being stuck to open as follows.
a. Connect vacuum pump to hose end.
b. Remove fuel gauge retainer with fuel gauge unit.
Always replace O-ring with new one.
c. Put fuel tank upside down.
d. Apply vacuum pressure to hose end [−13.3 kPa (−100 mmHg, −3.94 inHg)] with fuel gauge retainer
remaining open and check that the pressure is applicable.
PBIB1035E
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
EC
G
SEC921C
M
PBIB1588E
PBIB1589E
S-ET277
Fuel pressure at idling kPa (kg/cm2 , psi) Approximately 350 (3.57, 51)
A
Resistance [at 10 - 60°C (50 - 140°F)] 13.5 - 17.5Ω
EC
Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)] Approximately 0.2 - 5.0Ω
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
×:Applicable —: Not applicable
1
DTC*
Items MIL lighting
CONSULT-II Trip Reference page
(CONSULT-II screen terms) up
2 ECM*3
GST*
A/T INTERLOCK P1730 1730 1 × AT-147
A/T TCC S/V FNCTN P0744 0744 2 × AT-125
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
DTC*1
Items MIL lighting
CONSULT-II Trip Reference page
3 (CONSULT-II screen terms) up
2 ECM*
GST*
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
No DTC Flashing*4 FURTHER TESTING — Flashing*4 EC-718
MAY BE REQUIRED.
U1000 1000*5 CAN COMM CIRCUIT 1 × or — EC-792
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) “AIR BAG” and “SEAT
BELT PRE-TENSIONER” ABS00BYX
The Supplemental Restraint System such as “AIR BAG” and “SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER”, used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. This system includes seat belt switch inputs and dual stage front air bag modules. The SRS
system uses the seat belt switches to determine the front air bag deployment, and may only deploy one front
air bag, depending on the severity of a collision and whether the front occupants are belted or unbelted.
Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of this Service Man-
ual.
WARNING:
● To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
● Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section.
● Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harnesses or
harness connectors.
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine and A/T ABS00BYY
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) to warn the
driver of a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
CAUTION:
● Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the negative battery cable before any
repair or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves,
etc. will cause the MIL to light up.
● Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
cause the MIL to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
● Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-
locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG-74, "HAR-
NESS CONNECTOR" .
● Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness
with a bracket, etc. may cause the MIL to light up due to the short circuit.
● Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
may cause the MIL to light up due to the malfunction of the EVAP system or fuel injection system,
etc.
● Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM and
TCM (Transmission control module) before returning the vehicle to the customer.
Precaution ABS00BYZ
PBIB1164E
D
● When connecting ECM harness connector, fasten it
securely with a lever as far as it will go as shown in the fig-
ure. E
G
PBIB1512E
SEF217U
SEF348N
PBIB1144E
EC
PBIB1508E
D
● Do not depress accelerator pedal when starting.
● Immediately after starting, do not rev up engine unneces-
sarily. E
● Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.
G
SEF709Y
The actual shapes of Kent-Moore tools may differ from those of special service tools illustrated here.
Tool number
(Kent-Moore No.) Description
Tool name
S-NT564
S-NT379
S-NT636
LEC642
S-NT825
S-NT826
A
Tool name
Description
(Kent-Moore No.)
S-NT703
D
EVAP service port Applying positive pressure through EVAP service
adapter port
i.e.: (J-41413-OBD)
E
S-NT704
F
Fuel filler cap adapter Checking fuel tank vacuum relief valve opening
i.e.: (MLR-8382) pressure
G
H
S-NT815
S-NT705
S-NT779
PBIB2296E
EC
PBIB1143E
● Battery voltage Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
● Knock sensor Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
● Refrigerant pressure sensor EVAP canister purge volume control
EVAP canister purge flow control
● Stop lamp switch solenoid valve
● ICC steering switch Air conditioning cut control Air conditioner relay*4
● ICC brake switch Cooling fan control Cooling fan relay*4
● ASCD steering switch
● ASCD brake switch
● Fuel level sensor*1 *3
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Fuel tank temperature sensor*1
● Heated oxygen sensor 2*2
● TCM (Transmission control module)*3 ON BOARD DIAGNOSIS for EVAP system EVAP canister vent control valve
ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)*2 VDC/TCS operation command
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION I
The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined J
by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from both the crankshaft position sensor (POS), camshaft
position sensor (PHASE) and the mass air flow sensor.
VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION K
In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operat-
ing conditions as listed below.
<Fuel increase> L
● During warm-up
● When starting the engine
● During acceleration M
● Hot-engine operation
● When selector lever is changed from N to D
● High-load, high-speed operation
<Fuel decrease>
● During deceleration
● During high engine speed operation
PBIB0121E
The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for driveability and emission control.
The three way catalyst (manifold) can then better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses
heated oxygen sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor whether the engine operation is rich or lean. The
ECM adjusts the injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about
heated oxygen sensor 1, refer to EC-863 . This maintains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric
(ideal air-fuel mixture).
This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst (manifold). Even if the switching
characteristics of heated oxygen sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal
from heated oxygen sensor 2.
Open Loop Control
The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion.
● Deceleration and acceleration
● High-load, high-speed operation
● Malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1 or its circuit
● Insufficient activation of heated oxygen sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
● High engine coolant temperature
● During warm-up
● After shifting from N to D
● When starting the engine
MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from heated oxygen
sensor 1. This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to
the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as orig-
inally designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot film) and characteristic changes
during operation (i.e., injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio.
Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
then computed in terms of “injection pulse duration” to automatically compensate for the difference between
the two ratios.
“Fuel trim” refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
includes short term fuel trim and long term fuel trim.
“Short term fuel trim” is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
value. The signal from heated oxygen sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an
increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
“Long term fuel trim” is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short term fuel trim from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences,
wear over time and changes in the usage environment.
EC
PBIB0122E D
Two types of systems are used.
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected into each cylinder during each engine cycle according to the firing order. This system is used E
when the engine is running.
Simultaneous Multiport Fuel Injection System
F
Fuel is injected simultaneously into all eight cylinders twice each engine cycle. In other words, pulse signals of
the same width are simultaneously transmitted from the ECM.
The eight injectors will then receive the signals two times for each engine cycle.
This system is used when the engine is being started and/or if the fail-safe system (CPU) is operating. G
FUEL SHUT-OFF
Fuel to each cylinder is cut off during deceleration or operation of the engine at excessively high speeds. H
Electronic Ignition (EI) System ABS00BZ7
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-
fuel ratio for every running condition of the engine. The ignition tim-
ing data is stored in the ECM. This data forms the map shown.
The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and
camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition
signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
e.g., N: 1,800 rpm, Tp: 1.50 msec
A °BTDC
During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the
ECM according to the other data stored in the ECM.
● At starting SEF742M
● During warm-up
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
NTD control system decides the target traction based on the accelerator operation status and the current driv-
ing condition. It then selects the engine torque target by correcting running resistance and atmospheric pres-
sure, and controlling the power-train. Using electric throttle control actuator, it achieves the engine torque
development target which corresponds linearly to the driver's accelerator operation.
Running resistance correction control compares the engine torque estimate value, measured vehicle acceler-
ation, and running resistance on a flat road, and estimates vehicle weight gain and running resistance varia-
tion caused by slopes to correct the engine torque estimate value.
Atmospheric pressure correction control compares the engine torque estimate value from the airflow rate and
the target engine torque for the target traction, and estimates variation of atmospheric pressure to correct the
target engine torque. This system achieves powerful driving without reducing engine performance in the prac-
tical speed range in mountains and high-altitude areas.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used. G
Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
● When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed.
● When cranking the engine. H
● At high engine speeds.
● When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high.
● When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed. I
● When engine speed is excessively low.
● When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.
J
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Speed) ABS00BZA
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
If the engine speed is above 1,400 rpm under no load (for example, the shift position is neutral and engine
speed is over 1,400 rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies
based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will be operated until the engine speed reaches 1,000 rpm, then fuel cut will be cancelled.
NOTE:
This function is different from deceleration control listed under Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System, EC-679 .
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
Refer to LAN-6, "CAN Communication Unit" , about CAN communication for detail.
IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II EC
Check idle speed in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
E
SEF058Y
With GST
Check idle speed with GST. F
IGNITION TIMING
Any of following two methods may be used. G
Method A
1. Attach timing light to loop wire as shown.
H
PBIB1485E
K
2. Check ignition timing.
PBIB1487E
Method B
1. Remove No. 1 ignition coil.
PBIB1476E
PBIB1486E
SEF011V
PBIB1487E
PREPARATION A
1. Make sure that the following parts are in good order.
● Battery
● Ignition system
EC
● Engine oil and coolant levels
● Fuses
C
● ECM harness connector
● Vacuum hoses
● Engine compression E
● Throttle valve
2. On air conditioner equipped models, checks should be carried out while the air conditioner is OFF. F
3. On automatic transmission equipped models, when checking idle rpm, ignition timing and mixture ratio,
checks should be carried out while shift lever is in N position.
4. When measuring CO percentage, insert probe more than 40 cm (15.7 in) into tail pipe. G
5. Turn OFF headlamp, heater blower, rear window defogger.
6. Keep front wheels pointed straight ahead.
H
PBIB2001E
SEF976U
J
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or GST. K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2. L
M
SEF977U
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3.
PBIA8513J
SEF058Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 4.
>> GO TO 5.
>> GO TO 6.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10. SEF058Y H
NG >> GO TO 8.
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.)
M
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of all IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to
BL-208, "ECM Re-communicating Function" .
>> GO TO 4.
PBIB1487E
>> GO TO 12.
>> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 17.
PBIB1487E
E
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-196, "TIMING CHAIN" .
F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation. G
2. GO TO 4.
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.) L
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of all IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to
BL-208, "ECM Re-communicating Function" .
M
>> GO TO 4.
>> GO TO 26.
>> GO TO 27.
sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 31.
NG >> GO TO 30.
>> GO TO 34.
Revision: 2004 November EC-696 2004 FX35/FX45
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
[VK45DE]
31. REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 A
1. Stop engine.
2. Replace heated oxygen sensor 1 on the malfunctioning bank.
EC
With CONSULT-II>>GO TO 32.
Without CONSULT-II>>GO TO 33.
C
32. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 (BANK 1)/(BANK 2) SIGNAL
With CONSULT-II D
1. Start engine and warm it up until engine coolant temperature indicator points the middle of gauge.
2. See “HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2)” in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
3. Running engine at 2,000 rpm under no load (The engine is E
warmed up to normal operating temperature.), check that the
monitor fluctuates between LEAN and RICH more than 5 times
during 10 seconds.
F
1 time: RICH → LEAN → RICH
2 times: RICH → LEAN → RICH → LEAN → RICH
G
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4. PBIB0120E
NG >> GO TO 34.
H
33. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 (BANK 1)/(BANK 2) SIGNAL
Without CONSULT-II I
1. Set ECM to Self-diagnostic mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor). Refer to EC-719, "HOW TO
SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
2. Switch the monitored sensor to the malfunctioning bank. Refer to EC-719, "How to Switch Monitored Sen- J
sor From Bank 1 to Bank 2 or Vice Versa" .
3. Running engine at 2,000 rpm under no load (The engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature.),
check that the MIL comes on more than 5 times during 10 seconds. K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 34. L
>> GO TO 4.
>> GO TO 4.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ABS00BZE
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time
harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning ABS00BZF
DESCRIPTION
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully closed position of the throttle valve by
monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of
electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Make sure that throttle valve moves during above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
Idle Air Volume Learning ABS00BZG
DESCRIPTION
Idle Air Volume Learning is an operation to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine within the specific
range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
● Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
● Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
PREPARATION
Before performing Idle Air Volume Learning, make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
● Battery voltage: More than 12.9V (At idle)
● Engine coolant temperature: 70 - 100°C (158 - 212°F)
● PNP switch: ON
● Electric load switch: OFF
(Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
SEF217Z
I
6. Touch “START” and wait 20 seconds.
L
SEF454Y
Without CONSULT-II
NOTE:
● It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
● It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
1. Perform EC-698, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
SEC897C
12. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the
specifications.
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed 650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing 12 ± 5° BTDC (in P or N position)
13. If idle speed and ignition timing are not within the specification, Idle Air Volume Learning will not be carried
out successfully. In this case, find the cause of the incident by referring to the “DIAGNOSTIC PROCE-
DURE” below.
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
If idle air volume learning cannot be performed successfully, proceed as follows:
1. Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
2. Check PCV valve operation.
3. Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
4. When the above three items check out OK, engine component parts and their installation condi-
tion are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of the incident.
It is useful to perform EC-780, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
5. If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the
incident and perform Idle Air Volume Learning all over again:
● Engine stalls.
● Erroneous idle.
SEF214Y
D
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in IPDM E/R.
2. Start engine. E
3. After engine stalls, crank it 2 or 3 times to release all fuel pres-
sure.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF. F
5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
PBIB1482E
M
PBIB1489E
● Fuel pump
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system, which detects malfunctions related to engine sensors or actua-
tors. The ECM also records various emission-related diagnostic information including: EC
Emission-related diagnostic information SAE Mode
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Mode 3 of SAE J1979
Freeze Frame data Mode 2 of SAE J1979
C
The above information can be checked using procedures listed in the table below.
×: Applicable —: Not applicable
F
Freeze Frame 1st trip Freeze
DTC 1st trip DTC SRT code Test value
data Frame data
CONSULT-II × × × × × —
G
GST × × × — × ×
ECM × ×* — — — —
*: When DTC and 1st trip DTC simultaneously appear on the display, they cannot be clearly distinguished from each other. H
The malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel lights up when the same malfunction is detected
in two consecutive trips (Two trip detection logic), or when the ECM enters fail-safe mode. (Refer to EC-731 .)
I
Two Trip Detection Logic ABS00BZJ
When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
ECM memory. The MIL will not light up at this stage. <1st trip> J
If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
the ECM memory, and the MIL lights up. The MIL lights up at the same time when the DTC is stored. <2nd
trip> The “trip” in the “Two Trip Detection Logic” means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed K
during vehicle operation. Specific on board diagnostic items will cause the ECM to light up or blink the MIL,
and store DTC and Freeze Frame data, even in the 1st trip, as shown below.
×: Applicable —: Not applicable
L
MIL DTC 1st trip DTC
1st trip 2nd trip 2nd trip
Items 1st trip 2nd trip 1st trip
Lighting Lighting display-
Blinking Blinking displaying displaying displaying M
up up ing
When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the driver by lighting MIL up when there is
malfunction on engine control system.
Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related diagnoses are continuously detected as
NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open by means
of operating fail-safe function.
PBIB0911E
For example, the EGR malfunction (Priority: 2) was detected and the freeze frame data was stored in the 2nd
trip. After that when the misfire (Priority: 1) is detected in another trip, the freeze frame data will be updated C
from the EGR malfunction to the misfire. The 1st trip freeze frame data is updated each time a different mal-
function is detected. There is no priority for 1st trip freeze frame data. However, once freeze frame data is
stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze data is no longer stored (because only one freeze frame data or 1st D
trip freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM). If freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory and freeze
frame data with the same priority occurs later, the first (original) freeze frame data remains unchanged in the
ECM memory.
Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM mem- E
ory is erased. Procedures for clearing the ECM memory are described in EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE EMIS-
SION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
SYSTEM READINESS TEST (SRT) CODE F
System Readiness Test (SRT) code is specified in Mode 1 of SAE J1979.
As part of an enhanced emissions test for Inspection & Maintenance (I/M), certain states require the status of
SRT be used to indicate whether the ECM has completed self-diagnosis of major emission systems and com- G
ponents. Completion must be verified in order for the emissions inspection to proceed.
If a vehicle is rejected for a State emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating “INCMP”, use
the information in this Service Manual to set the SRT to “CMPLT”. H
In most cases the ECM will automatically complete its self-diagnosis cycle during normal usage, and the SRT
status will indicate “CMPLT” for each application system. Once set as “CMPLT”, the SRT status remains
“CMPLT” until the self-diagnosis memory is erased.
Occasionally, certain portions of the self-diagnostic test may not be completed as a result of the customer's I
normal driving pattern; the SRT will indicate “INCMP” for these items.
NOTE:
The SRT will also indicate “INCMP” if the self-diagnosis memory is erased for any reason or if the ECM mem- J
ory power supply is interrupted for several hours.
If, during the state emissions inspection, the SRT indicates “CMPLT” for all test items, the inspector will con-
tinue with the emissions test. However, if the SRT indicates “INCMP” for one or more of the SRT items the K
vehicle is returned to the customer untested.
NOTE:
If MIL is ON during the state emissions inspection, the vehicle is also returned to the customer untested even
though the SRT indicates “CMPLT” for all test items. Therefore, it is important to check SRT (“CMPLT”) and L
DTC (No DTCs) before the inspection.
SRT Item M
The table below shows required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to “CMPLT”.
SRT item Perfor-
Corresponding DTC
(CONSULT-II indica- mance Required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to “CMPLT”
No.
tion) Priority*
CATALYST 2 Three way catalyst function P0420, P0430
EVAP SYSTEM 1 EVAP control system P0442
2 EVAP control system P0456
2 EVAP control system purge flow monitoring P0441
HO2S 2 Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0133, P0153
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P1143, P1163
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P1144, P1164
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P0139, P0159
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P1146, P1166
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P1147, P1167
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results in a single cycle (Ignition OFF-ON-OFF), the SRT will
indicate “CMPLT”. → Case 1 above
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results through several different cycles, the SRT will indicate
“CMPLT” at the time the respective self-diagnoses have at least one OK result. → Case 2 above
If one or more SRT related self-diagnoses showed NG results in 2 consecutive cycles, the SRT will also indi-
cate “CMPLT”. → Case 3 above
The table above shows that the minimum number of cycles for setting SRT as “INCMP” is one (1) for each
self-diagnosis (Case 1 & 2) or two (2) for one of self-diagnoses (Case 3). However, in preparation for the state
emissions inspection, it is unnecessary for each self-diagnosis to be executed twice (Case 3) for the following
reasons:
● The SRT will indicate “CMPLT” at the time the respective self-diagnoses have one (1) OK result.
● The emissions inspection requires “CMPLT” of the SRT only with OK self-diagnosis results.
● When, during SRT driving pattern, 1st trip DTC (NG) is detected prior to “CMPLT” of SRT, the self-diagno-
sis memory must be erased from ECM after repair.
● If the 1st trip DTC is erased, all the SRT will indicate “INCMP”.
SEF573XA
EC
PBIB1053E
SEF414S
SCIA5334E
With GST
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting MODE 4 with GST.
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for A/T related items (see EC-662 ), skip step 2.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least 10
seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Perform AT-40, "HOW TO ERASE DTC (WITH GST)" . (The DTC in TCM will be erased.)
3. Select MODE 4 with GST (Generic Scan Tool).
No Tools
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for A/T related items (see EC-662 ), skip step 2.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once.
Wait at least 10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Perform AT-41, "HOW TO ERASE DTC (NO TOOLS)" . (The DTC in TCM will be erased.)
3. Change the diagnostic test mode from Mode II to Mode I by depressing the accelerator pedal. Refer to
EC-719, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
● If the battery is disconnected, the emission-related diagnostic information will be lost within 24
hours.
DESCRIPTION
J
The MIL is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MIL will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON with-
out the engine running. This is a bulb check.
K
If the MIL does not light up, refer to DI-39, "WARNING LAMPS" ,
or see EC-1318 .
2. When the engine is started, the MIL should go off.
If the MIL remains on, the on board diagnostic system has L
detected an engine system malfunction.
M
SEF217U
Engine stopped
Engine stopped
Engine running HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 This function allows the fuel mixture condition (lean or
MONITOR rich), monitored by heated oxygen sensor 1, to be read.
When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the driver by lighting MIL up when there is
malfunction on engine control system.
Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related diagnoses are continuously detected as
NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open by means
of operating fail-safe function.
The fail-safe function also operates when above diagnoses except MIL circuit are detected and demands the
driver to repair the malfunction.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode Engine speed will not rise more than 2,500 rpm due to the fuel cut
PBIB0092E I
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Monitor)
1. Set the ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-719, "How to Set Diagnostic
Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" . J
2. Start Engine.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor).
ECM will start heated oxygen sensor 1 monitoring from the bank 1 sensor. K
How to Switch Monitored Sensor From Bank 1 to Bank 2 or Vice Versa
1. Fully depress the accelerator pedal quickly and then release it immediately.
2. Make sure that monitoring sensor has changed by MIL blinking as follows. L
PBIB0093E
PBIA3905E
A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes. The “zero” is indicated
by the number of ten flashes. The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds
consisting of an ON (0.6-second) - OFF (0.6-second) cycle.
The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-second ON and 0.3-second OFF cycle.
A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-second OFF.
In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no mal-
function. (See EC-662, "INDEX FOR DTC" )
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
The DTC can be erased from the back up memory in the ECM by depressing accelerator pedal. Refer to EC-
719, "How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
● If the battery is disconnected, the DTC will be lost from the backup memory within 24 hours.
● Be careful not to erase the stored memory before starting trouble diagnoses.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II — HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 MONITOR
In this mode, the MIL displays the condition of the fuel mixture (lean or rich) which is monitored by the heated
oxygen sensor 1.
To check the heated oxygen sensor 1 function, start engine in the Diagnostic Test Mode II and warm it up until
C
engine coolant temperature indicator points to the middle of the gauge.
Next run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no load conditions. Then make sure that the
MIL comes ON more than 5 times within 10 seconds with engine running at 2,000 rpm under no load.
D
OBD System Operation Chart ABS00BZN
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MIL, 1ST TRIP DTC, DTC, AND DETECTABLE ITEMS
● When a malfunction is detected for the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip freeze frame data are E
stored in the ECM memory.
● When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, the DTC and the freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory, and the MIL will come on. For details, refer to EC-703, "Two Trip Detection
Logic" . F
● The MIL will go off after the vehicle is driven 3 times with no malfunction. The drive is counted only when
the recorded driving pattern is met (as stored in the ECM). If another malfunction occurs while counting,
the counter will reset. G
● The DTC and the freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 40 times (driving pattern A)
without the same malfunction recurring (except for Misfire and Fuel Injection System). For Misfire and
Fuel Injection System, the DTC and freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 80 times H
(driving pattern C) without the same malfunction recurring. The “TIME” in “SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS” mode of CONSULT-II will count the number of times the vehicle is driven.
● The 1st trip DTC is not displayed when the self-diagnosis results in OK for the 2nd trip. I
SUMMARY CHART
Items Fuel Injection System Misfire Other
J
MIL (goes off) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B)
DTC, Freeze Frame Data (no
80 (pattern C) 80 (pattern C) 40 (pattern A)
display)
K
1st Trip DTC (clear) 1 (pattern C), *1 1 (pattern C), *1 1 (pattern B)
1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
*1, *2 *1, *2 1 (pattern B)
(clear) L
For details about patterns B and C under “Fuel Injection System” and “Misfire”, see EC-723 .
For details about patterns A and B under “Other”, see EC-725 .
*1: Clear timing is at the moment OK is detected.
*2: Clear timing is when the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip.
M
SEF392S
*1: When the same malfunction is *2: MIL will go off after vehicle is driven *3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, 3 times (pattern B) without any mal- detected in two consecutive trips, the
MIL will light up. functions. DTC and the freeze frame data will
be stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data *5: When a malfunction is detected for *6: The 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip
will not be displayed any longer after the first time, the 1st trip DTC and freeze frame data will be cleared at
vehicle is driven 80 times (pattern C) the 1st trip freeze frame data will be the moment OK is detected.
without the same malfunction. (The stored in ECM.
DTC and the freeze frame data still
remain in ECM.)
*7: When the same malfunction is *8: 1st trip DTC will be cleared when
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip vehicle is driven once (pattern C)
freeze frame data will be cleared. without the same malfunction after
DTC is stored in ECM.
SEF393SD
*1: When the same malfunction is *2: MIL will go off after vehicle is driven *3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, 3 times (pattern B) without any mal- detected in two consecutive trips, the
MIL will light up. functions. DTC and the freeze frame data will
be stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data *5: When a malfunction is detected for *6: 1st trip DTC will be cleared after
will not be displayed any longer after the first time, the 1st trip DTC and vehicle is driven once (pattern B)
vehicle is driven 40 times (pattern A) the 1st trip freeze frame data will be without the same malfunction.
without the same malfunction. stored in ECM.
(The DTC and the freeze frame data
still remain in ECM.)
*7: When the same malfunction is
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared.
EC
G
AEC574
● The A counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected regardless of (1) - (4).
● The A counter will be counted up when (1) - (4) are satisfied without the same malfunction. H
● The DTC will not be displayed after the A counter reaches 40.
<Driving Pattern B>
I
Driving pattern B means the vehicle operation as follows:
All components and systems should be monitored at least once by the OBD system.
● The B counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected once regardless of the driving pattern.
J
● The B counter will be counted up when driving pattern B is satisfied without any malfunctions.
● The MIL will go off when the B counter reaches 3 (*2 in OBD SYSTEM OPERATION CHART).
K
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel con-
trol, ignition control, idle air control system, etc. The ECM accepts
input signals from sensors and instantly drives actuators. It is essen-
tial that both input and output signals are proper and stable. At the
same time, it is important that there are no malfunctions such as vac-
uum leaks, fouled spark plugs, or other malfunctions with the engine.
MEF036D
SEF233G
A visual check only may not find the cause of the incidents. A road
test with CONSULT-II (or GST) or a circuit tester connected should
be performed. Follow the Work Flow on EC-727 .
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such incidents, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the example
on EC-729 should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional malfunctions first.
This will help troubleshoot driveability malfunctions on an electroni-
SEF234G
cally controlled engine vehicle.
EC
PBIB1043E
*1 If time data of “SELF-DIAG *2 If the incident cannot be verified, per- *3 If the on board diagnostic system
RESULTS” is other than [0] or [1t], form EC-784, "TROUBLE DIAGNO- cannot be performed, check main
perform EC-784, "TROUBLE DIAG- SIS FOR INTERMITTENT power supply and ground circuit.
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI- INCIDENT" . Refer to EC-785, "POWER SUPPLY
DENT" . AND GROUND CIRCUIT" .
*4 If malfunctioning part cannot be *5 EC-713 *6 EC-780
detected, perform EC-784, "TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMIT-
TENT INCIDENT" .
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
Description
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about an incident. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one on the next page in order
to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
Some conditions may cause the MIL to come on steady or blink and
DTC to be detected. Examples:
● Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire. SEF907L
EC
MTBL0017
If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
chart.
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 and/or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-792 .
When the DTC listed below is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
P0102 Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
P0103
P1102
● When there is an open circuit on MIL circuit, the ECM cannot warn the driver by lighting up MIL when
there is malfunction on engine control system.
Therefore, when electrical controlled throttle and part of ECM related diagnoses are continuously detected
as NG for 5 trips, ECM warns the driver that engine control system malfunctions and MIL circuit is open by
means of operating fail-safe function.
The fail-safe function also operates when above diagnoses except MIL circuit are detected and demands
the driver to repair the malfunction.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode Engine speed will not rise more than 2,500 rpm due to the fuel cut
1. INSPECTION START A
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related malfunction, or a current need for
scheduled maintenance. EC
2. Open engine hood and check the following:
– Harness connectors for improper connections
– Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut C
– Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
– Hoses and ducts for leaks
D
– Air cleaner clogging
– Gasket
3. Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied. E
– Head lamp switch is OFF. SEF983U
SEF976U
J
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or GST. K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2. L
M
SEF977U
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3.
PBIA8513J
SEF058Y
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
650 ± 50 rpm (in P or N position)
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 4.
>> GO TO 5.
>> GO TO 6.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10. SEF058Y H
NG >> GO TO 8.
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.)
M
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of all IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to
EC-717, "IVIS (Infiniti Vehicle Immobilizer System — NATS)" .
>> GO TO 4.
PBIB1487E
>> GO TO 12.
>> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 17.
PBIB1487E
E
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-196, "TIMING CHAIN" .
F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation. G
2. GO TO 4.
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of an incident, but
this is a rare case.) L
2. Perform initialization of IVIS (NATS) system and registration of all IVIS (NATS) ignition key IDs. Refer to
EC-717, "IVIS (Infiniti Vehicle Immobilizer System — NATS)" .
M
>> GO TO 4.
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
ENGINE STALL
HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
D
ENGINE STALL E
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
ENGINE STALL
HESITATION/SURGING/FLAT SPOT
ROUGH IDLE/HUNTING
HIGH IDLE/LOW IDLE
page
IDLING VIBRATION
D
ENGINE STALL E
PBIB1471E
EC
PBIB1544E
PBIB1545E
EC
PBIB1546E
PBIB1543E
EC
PBIB1547E
TBWM0321E
EC
TBWM0520E
PBIB1192E
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the passenger side instrument lower
panel. For this inspection, remove passenger side instrument
lower panel.
2. Remove ECM harness connector.
PBIB1505E
PBIB1512E
Approximately 7V
EC
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1 C
2 L ● Engine speed is below 3,000 rpm
heater (bank 1)
PBIB0519E
D
[Engine is running] BATTERY VOLTAGE
● Engine speed is above 3,000 rpm (11 - 14V)
0 - 14V
PBIB1104E
0 - 14V H
[Ignition switch: ON]
Throttle control motor ● Engine stopped
5 L/B I
(Open) ● Shift lever position is D
● Accelerator pedal is fully depressed
PBIB1105E J
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm after the
following conditions are met K
– Engine: after warming up 0 - 1.0V
– Keeping the engine speed between 3,500
Heated oxygen sensor 2 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle for 1 L
6 R
heater (bank 1) minute under no load
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped BATTERY VOLTAGE M
[Engine is running] (11 - 14V)
● Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
[Engine is running]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● Warm-up condition
(11 - 14V)
● Idle speed
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
10 OR
solenoid valve (bank 1) [Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000rpm
PBIB1790E
Approximately 7V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
2 L ● Engine speed is below 3,000 rpm PBIB0519E
heater (bank 1)
0 - 14V
0 - 14V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm after the
following conditions are met
– Engine: after warming up 0 - 1.0V
– Keeping the engine speed between 3,500
Heated oxygen sensor 2 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle for 1
6 R
heater (bank 1) minute under no load
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Engine is running] (11 - 14V)
● Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
[Engine is running]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● Warm-up condition
(11 - 14V)
● Idle speed
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
10 OR
solenoid valve (bank 1) [Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000rpm PBIB1790E
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
C
11 BR
solenoid valve (bank 2) [Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
D
● Engine speed is 2,000rpm
PBIB1790E
E
[Engine is running]
0.5 - 4.5V
Power steering pressure ● Steering wheel is being turned
12 R/G
sensor [Engine is running]
0.4 - 0.8V F
● Steering wheel is not being turned
1.0 - 2.0V
[Engine is running] G
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE: H
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm
at idle
Crankshaft position sensor PBIB1041E
13 Y I
(POS)
1.0 - 2.0V
[Engine is running] J
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
K
PBIB1042E
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
L
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
M
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm
at idle
PBIB1039E
Camshaft position sensor
14 W
(PHASE)
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1040E
[Engine is running]
15 W Knock sensor 1 Approximately 2.5V
● Idle speed
[Engine is running]
Heated oxygen sensor 1 0 - Approximately 1.0V
16 R/L ● Warm-up condition
(bank 1) (Periodically change)
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB0043E
Approximately 7V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
24 BR ● Engine speed is below 3,000 rpm
heater (bank 2)
PBIB0519E
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm after the
following conditions are met
– Engine: after warming up 0 - 1.0V
– Keeping the engine speed between 3,500
Heated oxygen sensor 2 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle for 1
25 P
heater (bank 2) minute under no load
[Ignition switch: ON]
● Engine stopped BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Engine is running] (11 - 14V)
● Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
● Shift lever position is P or N
[Engine is running] BATTERY VOLTAGE
29 GY VIAS control solenoid valve
● Shift lever position is D (11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
● Engine speed is above 5,000 rpm
EVAP control system pres-
32 OR [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 1.8 - 4.8V
sure sensor
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Intake air temperature sen-
34 Y [Engine is running] Output voltage varies with intake
sor
air temperature.
[Engine is running] G
● Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
H
PBIB0051E
0 - 0.2V
[Engine is running] I
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
46 L Ignition signal No. 7 NOTE: J
60 SB Ignition signal No. 5 The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm
61 L Ignition signal No. 3 at idle
62 Y Ignition signal No. 1 PBIB0044E
M
PBIB0045E
0 - 1.0V
Intake valve timing control
53 R/L
position sensor (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB2046E
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm
Heated oxygen sensor 2
55 W/R quickly after the following conditions are met 0 - Approximately 1.0V
(bank 1)
– After keeping the engine speed between
3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle
for 1 minute under no load
[Engine is running]
Sensor ground
66 B ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V
(Throttle position sensor)
● Idle speed
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor / IAT
sensor / Power steering [Engine is running]
67 B/W pressure sensor / EVAP ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V
control system pressure ● Idle speed
sensor / Refrigerant pres-
sure sensor / ECT sensor)
Sensor power supply
68 SB (Power steering pressure [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 5V
sensor)
0 - 1.0V G
Intake valve timing control
72 BR
position sensor (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
H
● Engine speed is 2,000rpm
PBIB2046E I
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Engine coolant temperature
73 OR [Engine is running] Output voltage varies with
sensor
engine coolant temperature. J
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm K
Heated oxygen sensor 2
74 LG/B quickly after the following conditions are met 0 - Approximately 1.0V
(bank 2)
– After keeping the engine speed between
3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1 minute and at idle L
for 1 minute under no load
[Engine is running]
Sensor ground
78 B/R ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V M
(Heated oxygen sensor)
● Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Ignition switch: OFF]
104 L/OR Throttle control motor relay (11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch: ON] 0 - 1.0V
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
FUNCTION
Diagnostic test mode Function
This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
Work support
indications on the CONSULT-II unit.
Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
Self-diagnostic results
can be read and erased quickly.*
Data monitor Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.
Input/Output of the specification for Basic fuel schedule, AFM, A/F feedback control value and the
Data monitor (SPEC)
other data monitor items can be read.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
If CONSULT-II is used with no connection of CONSULT-II CONVERTER, malfunctions might be
detected in self-diagnosis depending on control unit which carry out CAN communication.
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect CONSULT-II and CONSULT-II CONVERTER to data
link connector, which is located under LH dash panel near the
hood opener handle.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB1503E
EC
MBIB0233E
D
5. Touch “ENGINE”.
If “ENGINE” is not indicated, go to GI-40, "CONSULT-II Data
Link Connector (DLC) Circuit" .
E
G
SEF995X
PBIB2308E
K
WORK SUPPORT MODE
Work Item
L
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE ● FUEL PUMP WILL STOP BY TOUCHING “START” DUR- When releasing fuel pressure
ING IDLING. from fuel line
CRANK A FEW TIMES AFTER ENGINE STALLS. M
IDLE AIR VOL LEARN ● THE IDLE AIR VOLUME THAT KEEPS THE ENGINE When learning the idle air volume
WITHIN THE SPECIFIED RANGE IS MEMORIZED IN
ECM.
SELF-LEARNING CONT ● THE COEFFICIENT OF SELF-LEARNING CONTROL When clearing the coefficient of
MIXTURE RATIO RETURNS TO THE ORIGINAL COEF- self-learning control value
FICIENT.
RICH: means the mixture became “rich”, “RICH” is displayed until air-fuel mix-
and control is being affected toward a ture ratio feedback control begins.
HO2S1 MNTR (B2) leaner mixture. ● When the air-fuel ratio feedback is
× LEAN: means the mixture became “lean”,
[RICH/LEAN] clamped, the value just before the
and control is being affected toward a rich clamping is displayed continuously.
mixture.
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) ● Display of heated oxygen sensor 2 signal:
×
[RICH/LEAN] RICH: means the amount of oxygen after
● When the engine is stopped, a cer-
three way catalyst is relatively small.
HO2S2 MNTR (B2) tain value is indicated.
× LEAN: means the amount of oxygen after
[RICH/LEAN] three way catalyst is relatively large.
● The vehicle speed computed from the vehi-
VHCL SPEED SE
× × cle speed signal sent from combination
[km/h] or [mph]
meter is displayed.
INT/V SOL (B1) [%] ● The control value of the intake valve timing
G
control solenoid valve (determined by ECM
according to the input signals) is indicated.
INT/V SOL (B2) [%] H
● The advance angle becomes larger as the
value increases.
● The control condition of the VIAS control
solenoid valve (determined by ECM accord- I
ing to the input signals) is indicated.
VIAS S/V
[ON/OFF] ● OFF: VIAS control solenoid valve is not
operating.
J
ON: VIAS control solenoid valve is operat-
ing.
● The air conditioner relay control condition
AIR COND RLY K
× (determined by ECM according to the input
[ON/OFF]
signals) is indicated.
● Indicates the fuel pump relay control condi-
FUEL PUMP RLY L
× tion determined by ECM according to the
[ON/OFF]
input signals.
● The control condition of the EVAP canister
vent control valve (determined by ECM M
VENT CONT/V
according to the input signals) is indicated.
[ON/OFF]
ON: Closed
OFF: Open
● Indicates the throttle control motor relay
THRTL RELAY
control condition determined by the ECM
[ON/OFF]
according to the input signals.
● The control condition of the cooling fan
(determined by ECM according to the input
COOLING FAN
signals) is indicated.
[HI/OFF]
HI: High speed operation
OFF: Stop
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF] ● Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 1 heater determined by
HO2S1 HTR (B2) ECM according to the input signals.
[ON/OFF]
PBIB0197E
DESCRIPTION
Generic Scan Tool (OBDII scan tool) complying with SAE J1978 has
8 different functions explained below.
ISO9141 is used as the protocol.
The name “GST” or “Generic Scan Tool” is used in this service man-
ual.
SEF139P
This mode gains access to current emission-related data values, including analog inputs
MODE 1 READINESS TESTS
and outputs, digital inputs and outputs, and system status information.
EC
This mode gains access to emission-related data value which were stored by ECM during
MODE 2 (FREEZE DATA) the freeze frame. For details, refer to EC-708, "FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP
FREEZE FRAME DATA" .
This mode gains access to emission-related power train trouble codes which were stored C
MODE 3 DTCs
by ECM.
This mode can clear all emission-related diagnostic information. This includes:
● Clear number of diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 1) D
● Clear diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 3)
MODE 4 CLEAR DIAG INFO ● Clear trouble code for freeze frame data (MODE 1)
E
● Clear freeze frame data (MODE 2)
● Reset status of system monitoring test (MODE 1)
● Clear on board monitoring test results (MODE 6 and 7)
F
This mode accesses the results of on board diagnostic monitoring tests of specific com-
MODE 6 (ON BOARD TESTS)
ponents/systems that are not continuously monitored.
This mode enables the off board test drive to obtain test results for emission-related pow-
G
MODE 7 (ON BOARD TESTS) ertrain components/systems that are continuously monitored during normal driving condi-
tions.
This mode can close EVAP system in ignition switch ON position (Engine stopped). When
this mode is performed, EVAP canister vent control valve can be closed. H
In the following conditions, this mode cannot function.
● Low ambient temperature
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. L
2. Connect “GST” to data link connector, which is located under LH
dash panel near the hood opener handle.
M
PBIB1503E
SEF398S
SEF416S
Remarks: A
● Specification data are reference values.
● Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
i.e. Adjust ignition timing with a timing light before monitoring IGN TIMING, because the monitor may show the specification data in EC
spite of the ignition timing not being adjusted to the specification data. This IGN TIMING monitors the data calculated by the ECM
according to the signals input from the camshaft position sensor and other ignition timing related sensors.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
● Run engine and compare the CONSULT-II value with tachometer indica- Almost the same speed as the C
ENG SPEED
tion tachometer indication
MAS A/F SE-B1 See EC-780, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
B/FUEL SCHDL See EC-780, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
D
A/F ALPHA-B1
See EC-780, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
A/F ALPHA-B2
E
COOLAN TEMP/S ● Engine: After warming up More than 70°C (158°F)
HO2S1 (B1) Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 0 - 0.3V ←→ Approx. 0.6 -
● Engine: After warming up
HO2S1 (B2) rpm 1.0V
F
● Warm-up condition
● After keeping engine speed
HO2S2 (B1) Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V ←→ Approx. 0.6 -
HO2S2 (B2) between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for quickly 1.0V
1 minute and at idle for 1 minute G
under no load
LEAN ←→ RICH
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 H
● Engine: After warming up Changes more than 5 times
HO2S1 MNTR (B2) rpm
during 10 seconds
● Warm-up condition
● After keeping engine speed I
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) Revving engine from idle to 3,000 rpm
between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for LEAN ←→ RICH
HO2S2 MNTR (B2) quickly
1 minute and at idle for 1 minute
under no load
J
● Turn drive wheels and compare the CONSULT-II value with speedometer Almost the same speed as the
VEH SPEED SE
indication speedometer indication
BATTERY VOLT ● Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V K
● Ignition switch: ON Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.5 - 1.0V
ACCEL SEN1
(Engine stopped) Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed 4.0 - 4.7V
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.3 - 1.2V
L
● Ignition switch: ON
ACCEL SEN2*
(Engine stopped) Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed 3.9 - 4.8V
● Ignition switch: ON Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
THRTL SEN1 M
(Engine stopped)
THRTL SEN2* Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
● Shift lever: D
EVAP SYS PRES ● Ignition switch: ON Approx. 1.8 - 4.8V
START SIGNAL ● Ignition switch: ON → START → ON OFF → ON → OFF
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in “DATA MONITOR” mode.
CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1, THRTL SEN 1
Below is the data for “CLSD THL POS”, “ACCEL SEN 1” and “THRTL SEN 1” when depressing the accelera-
tor pedal with the ignition switch ON and with selector lever in D position.
The signal of “ACCEL SEN 1” and “THRTL SEN 1” should rise gradually without any intermittent drop or rise
after “CLSD THL POS” is changed from “ON” to “OFF”.
PBIB0198E
ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1), INJ PULSE-B1
Below is the data for “ENG SPEED”, “MAS A/F SE-B1”, “THRTL SEN 1”, “HO2S2 (B1)”, “HO2S1 (B1)” and
“INJ PULSE-B1” when revving engine quickly up to 4,800 rpm under no load after warming up engine suffi-
ciently.
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary.
PBIB2445E
EC
PBIB0668E
Description ABS00C01
The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in “DATA MONITOR (SPEC)”
mode of CONSULT-II during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in “DATA MONI-
TOR (SPEC)” mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value in
“DATA MONITOR (SPEC)” mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one or
more malfunctions.
The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the
MIL.
The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
● B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board cor-
rection)
● A/F ALPHA-B1/B2 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
● MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor)
Testing Condition ABS00C02
NOTE:
Perform “DATA MONITOR (SPEC)” mode in maximum scale display.
1. Perform EC-733, "Basic Inspection" .
2. Confirm that the testing conditions indicated above are met.
3. Select “B/FUEL SCHDL”, “A/F ALPHA-B1”, “A/F ALPHA-B2”
and “MAS A/F SE-B1” in “DATA MONITOR (SPEC)” mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value.
5. If NG, go to EC-781, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF601Z
EC
SEF613ZD
SEF768Z
EC
SEF615ZA
Description ABS00C05
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the malfunction resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's
complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occur-
rences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may
not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the
specific malfunctioning area.
Common I/I Report Situations
STEP in Work Flow Situation
II The CONSULT-II is used. The SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen shows time data other than [0] or [1t].
III The symptom described by the customer does not recur.
IV (1st trip) DTC does not appear during the DTC Confirmation Procedure.
VI The Diagnostic Procedure for PXXXX does not indicate the malfunctioning area.
1. INSPECTION START
Erase (1st trip) DTCs. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMA-
TION" .
>> GO TO 2.
EC
TBWM0217E
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
WIRE
MINAL ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
COLOR
NO.
[Engine is running]
1 B ECM ground Body ground
● Idle speed
[Ignition switch: OFF] 0V
109 W/L Ignition switch BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Ignition switch: ON]
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch: OFF]
0 - 1.5V
● For a few seconds after turning ignition
ECM relay switch OFF
111 W/B
(Self shut-off)
[Ignition switch: OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● More than a few seconds after turning igni- (11 - 14V)
tion switch OFF
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 8.
No >> GO TO 2.
MBIB0015E
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
H
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5. I
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1514E
PBIB1191E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
12. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-VI
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector. H
2. Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector E9.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 111 and IPDM E/R terminal 46.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. I
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
A
Ground connections are very important to the proper operation of electrical and electronic circuits. Ground
connections are often exposed to moisture, dirt and other corrosive elements. The corrosion (rust) can
become an unwanted resistance. This unwanted resistance can change the way a circuit works.
Electronically controlled circuits are very sensitive to proper grounding. A loose or corroded ground can drasti- EC
cally affect an electronically controlled circuit. A poor or corroded ground can easily affect the circuit. Even
when the ground connection looks clean, there can be a thin film of rust on the surface.
When inspecting a ground connection follow these rules: C
● Remove the ground bolt or screw.
● Inspect all mating surfaces for tarnish, dirt, rust, etc.
● Clean as required to assure good contact. D
● Reinstall bolt or screw securely.
● Inspect for “add-on” accessories which may be interfering with the ground circuit.
● If several wires are crimped into one ground eyelet terminal, check for proper crimps. Make sure all of the E
wires are clean, securely fastened and providing a good ground path. If multiple wires are cased in one
eyelet make sure no ground wires have excess wire insulation.
For detailed ground distribution information, refer to PG-31, "Ground Distribution" . F
PBIB1870E L
Description ABS00C0A
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C0B
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
EC
TBWM0218E
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM function ECM Actuator EC
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Intake valve timing control position sensor Intake valve timing signal Intake valve Intake valve timing control C
timing control solenoid valve
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Wheel sensor* Vehicle speed
D
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line
PBIB1669E
J
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant K
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing (IVT) control sole-
noid valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake
valve to increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range. L
COMPONENT INSPECTION
Intake Valve Timing Control Solenoid Valve
Intake Valve Timing (IVT) control solenoid valve is activated by ON/ M
OFF pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
The IVT control solenoid valve changes the oil amount and direction
of flow through intake valve timing control unit or stops oil flow.
The longer pulse width advances valve angle.
The shorter pulse width retards valve angle.
When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
stops oil pressure flow to fix the intake valve angle at the control
position.
PBIB1842E
SEF359Z
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Intake valve timing control The signal is not energized to the solenoid valve and the valve control does not function
A
CAUTION:
Always drive at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC P0011 or P0021 is displayed with DTC P1111, P1136, P1140 or P1145, first perform the trou- EC
ble diagnosis for EC-1070 or EC-1095 .
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test. C
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10V and 16V at
idle. D
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
With CONSULT-II
E
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Maintain the following conditions for at least 10 consecutive sec- F
onds.
ENG SPEED More than 2,000 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70°C (158°F) G
Selector lever 1st or 2nd position
Driving vehicle uphill
H
Driving location uphill (Increased engine load will help maintain the driving con-
ditions required for this test.)
SEF353Z
BANK 1
TBWM0277E
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition 0 - 1.0V
G
● Idle speed
0 - 1.0V H
Intake valve timing control
72 BR
position sensor (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm I
PBIB2046E J
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
TBWM0278E
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition 0 - 1.0V
G
● Idle speed
0 - 1.0V H
Intake valve timing control
53 R/L
position sensor (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm I
PBIB2046E J
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1517E
SEF509Y
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between intake valve timing control position sensor terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
8. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT J
1. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
PBIB1517E
PBIB0192E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR
OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 10 and intake valve timing control solenoid valve (bank
1) terminal 1 or ECM terminal 11 and intake valve timing control solenoid valve (bank 2) terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
SEF362Z
PBIB0194E
I
M
PBIB0193E
Description ABS00C0N
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed Heated oxygen sensor 1
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
heater control
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine speed
and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine is
started.
OPERATION
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,000 OFF
Below 3,000 after warming up ON
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
P0031 The current amperage in the heated oxygen
0031 sensor 1 heater circuit is out of the normal ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen (The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater circuit is
range.
sensor 1 heater open or shorted.)
P0051 (An excessively low voltage signal is sent to
control circuit low
0051 ECM through the heated oxygen sensor 1 ● Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
(Bank 2) heater.)
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II C
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
D
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
E
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-811, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
G
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above. H
BANK 1
TBWM0221E
[Engine is running] D
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
2 L ● Engine speed is below 3,000 rpm
heater (bank 1)
E
PBIB0519E
TBWM0222E
[Engine is running] D
● Warm-up condition
Heated oxygen sensor 1
24 BR ● Engine speed is below 3,000 rpm
heater (bank 2)
E
PBIB0519E
PBIB2195E L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections. M
PBIB1521E
PBIB0969E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0970E
L
Removal and Installation ABS00C0U
Description ABS00C0V
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature heater control
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed,
amount of intake air and engine coolant temperature.
OPERATION
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 rpm after the following conditions are met.
● Engine: After warming up
ON
● Keeping the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for 1
minute and at idle for 1 minute under no load
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
P0037
0037 The current amperage in the heated oxygen sen- ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen (The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater circuit is
sor 2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
sensor 2 heater open or shorted.)
P0057 (An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
control circuit low
0057 through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.) ● Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
(Bank 2)
P0038
0038 The current amperage in the heated oxygen sen- ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sor 2 heater circuit is out of the normal range. (The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater circuit is
sensor 2 heater (An excessively high voltage signal is sent to shorted.)
P0058 control circuit high ECM through the heated oxygen sensor 2
0058 heater.) ● Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
(Bank 2)
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II C
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera- D
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start the engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 rpm E
and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-819, "Diagnostic Procedure" F
. SEF174Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1
TBWM0223E
TBWM0224E
PBIB2195E
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
M
PBIB1534E
PBIB0969E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0970E
L
Removal and Installation ABS00C12
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
SEC266C
A
Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A first.
If the DTC cannot be confirmed, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at EC
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A C
NOTE:
If engine will not start or stops soon, wait at least 10 seconds with engine stopped (Ignition switch ON) instead
of running engine at idle speed.
D
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. E
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Run engine for at least 10 seconds at idle speed.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-826, "Diagnostic Procedure" . F
SEF174Y H
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
I
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed. J
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. K
If engine cannot be started, go to EC-826, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
L
4. Check the voltage of “MAS A/F SE-B1” with “DATA MONITOR”.
5. Increases engine speed to about 4,000 rpm.
6. Monitor the linear voltage rise in response to engine speed
M
increases.
If NG, go to EC-826, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
SEF243Y
SEF534P
EC
TBWM0225E
1. INSPECTION START
Which malfunction (A or B) is duplicated?
A or B
A >> GO TO 3.
B >> GO TO 2.
E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4. F
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1502E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal 51.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
● Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
SEC266C
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-833, "Diagnostic Procedure" . D
F
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above. G
SEF058Y
L
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
M
TBWM0225E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1502E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT E
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal 51.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
F
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG G
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
H
8. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-829, "Component Inspection" .
I
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
J
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-784, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" . K
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation ABS00C1J
The intake air temperature sensor is built-into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to EC
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise. C
SEC266C
E
<Reference data>
Intake air temperature
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ F
°C (°F)
-10 (14) 4.43 7.9 - 9.3
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1 G
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 34
(Intake air temperature sensor) and ground. H
CAUTION: SEF012P
SEF058Y
EC
TBWM0226E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1502E
PBIB0066E
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature K
sensor).
L
SEC266C
SEF012P
SEF594K
<Reference data>
Engine coolant temperature
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
°C (°F)
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 73
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION: SEF012P
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning ignition switch ON
or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Engine coolant temperature decided
Condition
(CONSULT-II display)
Engine coolant temper- Just as ignition switch is turned ON or START 40°C (104°F)
ature sensor circuit
More than approx. 4 minutes after ignition ON or START 80°C (176°F)
40 - 80°C (104 - 176°F)
Except as shown above
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling fan operates
while engine is running.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. C
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-845, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
D
F
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above. G
TBWM0227E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG F
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
G
2. CHECK ECT SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor harness connector.
H
K
PBIB1515E
PBIB0080E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB2005E
D
Removal and Installation ABS00C1X
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-851, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0429E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1480E
PBIB0082E
C
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
D
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 5 and ECM terminal 66. E
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
F
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. G
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT H
1. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 2 and ECM terminal 69.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
I
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG J
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
K
9. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-854, "Component Inspection" .
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
M
10. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next PBIB1530E
step.
7. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Removal and Installation ABS00C25
NOTE:
If DTC P0125 is displayed with P0117 or P0118, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0117 or EC
P0118. Refer to EC-842 .
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant C
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases. D
SEF594K
F
<Reference data>
Engine coolant
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
temperature °C (°F) G
-10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
H
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 73 I
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground. SEF012P
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam- J
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C27
K
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
L
● Voltage sent to ECM from the sensor is not ● Harness or connectors
Insufficient engine cool- practical, even when some time has passed (High resistance in the circuit)
P0125 after starting the engine.
ant temperature for
0125 ● Engine coolant temperature sensor
closed loop fuel control ● Engine coolant temperature is insufficient for M
closed loop fuel control. ● Thermostat
CAUTION:
Be careful not to overheat engine.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Check that “COOLAN TEMP/S” is above 10°C (50°F).
If it is above 10°C (50°F), the test result will be OK.
If it is below 10°C (50°F), go to following step.
4. Start engine and run it for 65 minutes at idle speed.
If “COOLAN TEMP/S” increases to more than 10°C (50°F)
within 65 minutes, stop engine because the test result will
be OK.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-856, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C29
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB2005E I
<Reference data>
J
Engine coolant
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
temperature °C (°F)
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
K
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal L
73 (Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor. SEF012P
M
Removal and Installation ABS00C2B
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
SEC266C
<Reference data>
Intake air temperature
Voltage* V Resistance kΩ
°C (°F)
–10 (14) 4.43 7.9 - 9.3
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 34
(Intake air temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION: SEF012P
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
TESTING CONDITION:
This test may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road
test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Wait until engine coolant temperature is less than 90°C (194°F)
a. Turn ignition switch ON.
secutive seconds. D
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-859, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST E
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C2F
F
1. CHECK GROUND CONNECTIONS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten three ground screws on the body. G
Refer to EC-791, "Ground Inspection" .
PBIB2195E
K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
L
2. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-841, "Component Inspection" . M
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
SEC266C
SEF012P
Engine coolant temperature has not risen enough to open the thermostat even though the engine has run long
enough. EC
This is due to a leak in the seal or the thermostat stuck open.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Thermostat
C
The engine coolant temperature does not
P0128 ● Leakage from sealing portion of thermo-
Thermostat function reach to specified temperature even though
0128 stat
the engine has run long enough.
● Engine coolant temperature sensor
D
NOTE: E
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: F
● For best results, perform at ambient temperature of –10°C (14°F) or higher.
● For best results, perform at engine coolant temperature of –10°C (14°F) to 60°C (140°F).
G
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Replace thermostat with new one. Refer to CO-51, "THERMOSTAT AND WATER CONTROL VALVE" .
Use only a genuine NISSAN thermostat as a replacement. If an incorrect thermostat is used, the MIL may
H
come on.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Select “COOLAN TEMP/S” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
I
4. Check that the “COOLAN TEMP/S” is above 60°C (140°F).
If it is below 60°C (140°F), go to following step.
If it is above 60°C (140°F), cool down the engine to less than 60°C (140°F), then retry from step 1.
J
5. Drive vehicle for 10 consecutive minutes under the following conditions.
VHCL SPEED SE 80 - 120 km/h (50 - 75 MPH)
K
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-861, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
1. Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above. L
PBIB2005E
<Reference data>
Temperature °C (°F) Resistance kΩ
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.0
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
SEF463R
H
SEF288D
PBIB1847E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor An excessively high voltage from the sensor is (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0152 1 circuit high voltage sent to ECM.
● Heated oxygen sensor 1
0152
(Bank 2)
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-868, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0228E
EC
TBWM0229E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1520E
>> GO TO 3.
EC
PBIB1521E
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor J
P0132 16 1 1
P0152 35 1 2
K
Continuity should exist.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
L
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor M
P0132 16 1 1
P0152 35 1 2
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
EC
SEF648Y
CAUTION: D
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread E
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
F
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
G
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
H
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least 1 time.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one. K
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
L
Removal and Installation ABS00C2U
SEF463R
SEF288D
SEF010V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause A
P0133 ● Harness or connectors
0133 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) ● Heated oxygen sensor 1 EC
● Fuel pressure
Heated oxygen sensor The response of the voltage signal from the ● Fuel injector
P0153 1 circuit slow response sensor takes more than the specified time.
0153
● Intake air leaks C
(Bank 2) ● Exhaust gas leaks
● PCV valve
● Mass air flow sensor D
CAUTION: E
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at F
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Always perform at a temperature above −10°C (14°F). G
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
H
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “HO2S1 (B1) P0133” or “HO2S1 (B2) P0153” of “HO2S1” in “DTC
I
WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch “START”.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes. J
NOTE:
Do not raise engine speed above 3,000 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
K
SEF338Z
step 2.
SEF658Y
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1(B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
– The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V more
than 5 times within 10 seconds.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V → 0.6 - 1.0V → 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V → 0.6 - 1.0V → 0 - 0.3V → 0.6 - 1.0V
→ 0 - 0.3V
4. If NG, go to EC-878, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1528E
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0228E
EC
TBWM0229E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1520E
>> GO TO 3.
SEC502D
E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace. F
SEF968Y
With GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0174 or P0172, P0175 detected? PBIB1502E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174 or DTC P0172, P0175 (Refer to EC-914 or EC-
923 ).
No >> GO TO 6.
PBIB1521E
E
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
G
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 H
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
I
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and J
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load. K
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least 1 time. L
● The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least 1 time.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation ABS00C33
SEF463R
SEF288D
SEF237U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
Heated oxygen sensor ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) The voltage from the sensor is constantly
1 circuit no activity (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0154 approx. 0.3V.
detected ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
0154
(Bank 2)
A
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at EC
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle. C
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
D
2. Select “HO2S1 (B1) P0134” or “HO2S1 (B2) P0154” of “HO2S1” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Touch “START”.
E
4. Let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not raise engine speed above 3,000 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 4. F
PBIB0544E
H
5. When the following conditions are met, “TESTING” will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until “TESTING” changes to “COMPLETED”. (It will I
take approximately 10 to 60 seconds.)
ENG SPEED 1,000 - 2,300 rpm
J
VHCL SPEED SE More than 64 km/h (40 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 1.5 - 15.0 msec
Selector lever Suitable position K
If “TESTING” is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from PBIB0545E
step 2.
6. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG L
RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-890, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
M
SEC750C
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
– The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 to 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-890, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1528E
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0228E
EC
TBWM0229E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
EC
PBIB1521E
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor J
P0134 16 1 1
P0154 35 1 2
K
Continuity should exist.
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 E
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant. F
Removal and Installation ABS00C3C
PBIB1848E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor An excessively high voltage from the sensor is (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0158 2 circuit high voltage sent to ECM.
● Heated oxygen sensor 2
0158
(Bank 2)
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
C
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
D
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 2 minutes. E
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-899, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. SEF174Y
WITH GST F
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1
TBWM0230E
TBWM0231E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
L
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1534E
SEF662Y
PBIB1624E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.62V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 55 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 74 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
6. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.62V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.62V at step 6, step 7 is not neces-
sary.
7. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with “OD” OFF.
The voltage should be below 0.48V at least once during this PBIB2024E
procedure.
8. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads (using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12) and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation ABS00C3K
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00C3M
SEF302U
L
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0139 ● Harness or connectors
M
0139 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) ● Heated oxygen sensor 2
Heated oxygen sensor It takes more time for the sensor to respond
P0159 2 circuit slow response between rich and lean than the specified time. ● Fuel pressure
0159 ● Fuel injector
(Bank 2)
● Intake air leaks
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
For better results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C
(158°F). SEF174Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
7. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P0139” or “HO2S2 (B2) P0159” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
8. Start engine and following the instruction of CONSULT-II.
PBIB0115E
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 55 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 74 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
BANK 1
TBWM0230E
TBWM0231E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
L
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
SEF968Y
With GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0174 or P0172, P0175 detected? PBIB1502E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174 or P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-914 or EC-923 .
No >> GO TO 3.
PBIB1534E
E
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
SEF174Y
SEF662Y
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.
PBIB1624E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.62V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
With the Air-Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (the actual mixture ratio is too lean.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and lights up the MIL (2 trip detection logic).
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas Fuel injection
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Fuel injector
(Mixture ratio feedback signal) control
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
P0171 ● Intake air leaks
0171 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
(Bank 1)
● Fuel injector
● Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
Fuel injection system ● Exhaust gas leaks
too lean ● The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
P0174 ● Incorrect fuel pressure
large. (The mixture ratio is too lean.)
0174 ● Lack of fuel
(Bank 2)
● Mass air flow sensor
● Incorrect PCV hose connection
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching “CLEAR”.
5. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 should be detected at this
stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-918, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine
starts, go to EC-918, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not SEF968Y
start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
BANK 1
TBWM0232E
EC
TBWM0233E
SEC502D
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
PBIB1521E
E
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
Terminals
DTC Bank
ECM Sensor G
P0171 16 1 1
P0174 35 1 2
H
Continuity should exist.
E
PBIB0133E
Without CONSULT-II F
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard. G
PBIB1986E
J
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-1274, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" . K
8. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle. L
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect all injector harness connectors.
4. Remove injector gallery assembly. Refer to EM-188, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" . M
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
5. For DTC P0171, reconnect injector harness connectors on bank 1.
For DTC P0174, reconnect injector harness connectors on bank 2.
6. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
7. Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
8. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
For DTC P0171, make sure that fuel sprays out from injectors
on bank 1.
For DTC P0174, make sure that fuel sprays out from injectors
on bank 2.
Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each injector.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace injectors from which fuel does not spray out.
Always replace O-ring with new ones. PBIB1726E
With the Air-Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The EC
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (the actual mixture ratio is too rich.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and lights up the MIL (2 trip detection logic). C
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas Fuel injection D
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Fuel injector
(Mixture ratio feedback signal) control
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause E
name
P0172 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
0172
● Fuel injection system does not operate properly. ● Fuel injector
(Bank 1) Fuel injection system F
● The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too ● Exhaust gas leaks
P0175 too rich
large. (The mixture ratio is too rich.) ● Incorrect fuel pressure
0175
(Bank 2) ● Mass air flow sensor G
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS00C3Z
NOTE: H
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II I
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CON- J
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching “CLEAR”.
5. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. K
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 should be detected at this
stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-927, "Diagnostic L
Procedure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too. M
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-927, "Diagnostic Procedure" . SEF968Y
If engine does not start, remove ignition plugs and check for
fouling, etc.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0232E
TBWM0233E
E
SEC502D
OK or NG
F
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG H
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
I
PBIB1521E
PBIB0133E
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
PBIB1986E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-1274, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
8. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Remove injector assembly. Refer to EM-188, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
2. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
3. Disconnect all injector harness connectors.
4. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
5. Prepare pans or saucers under each injectors.
6. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one.
The fuel tank temperature sensor is used to detect the fuel tempera-
ture inside the fuel tank. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from EC
the ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the fuel temper-
ature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to the
change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases as temperature increases. C
PBIB1507E
E
<Reference data>
Fluid temperature Voltage* Resistance
F
°C (°F) V kΩ
20 (68) 3.5 2.3 - 2.7
50 (122) 2.2 0.79 - 0.90 G
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 107
(Fuel tank temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION: H
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output SEF012P
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground. I
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C43
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause J
Rationally incorrect voltage from the sensor is ● Harness or connectors
Fuel tank temperature
P0181 sent to ECM, compared with the voltage sig- (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
sensor circuit range/
0181 nals from engine coolant temperature sensor K
performance ● Fuel tank temperature sensor
and intake air temperature sensor.
L
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
M
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 10 seconds.
If the result is NG, go to EC-934, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If the result is OK, go to following step.
4. Check “COOLAN TEMP/S” value.
If “COOLAN TEMP/S” is less than 60°C (140°F), the result will
be OK.
If “COOLAN TEMP/S” is above 60°C (140°F), go to the following
step.
SEF174Y
5. Cool engine down until “COOLAN TEMP/S” is less than 60°C
(140°F).
6. Wait at least 10 seconds.
7. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-934, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
EC
TBWH0109E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1507E
4. Check voltage between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
terminal 4 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Approximately 5V
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0932E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connector.
C
5. CHECK FUEL TANK TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. D
2. Disconnect “unified meter and A/C amp.” harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” terminal 5 and “unified meter and
A/C amp.” terminal 36. Refer to Wiring Diagram. E
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power. F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6. G
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following. H
● Harness connectors B1, M11
● Harness for open or short between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” and “unified meter and A/C
amp.” I
PBIB0931E
The fuel tank temperature sensor is used to detect the fuel tempera-
ture inside the fuel tank. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from EC
the ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the fuel temper-
ature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to the
change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases as temperature increases. C
PBIB1507E
E
<Reference data>
Fluid temperature Voltage* Resistance
F
°C (°F) V kΩ
20 (68) 3.5 2.3 - 2.7
50 (122) 2.2 0.79 - 0.90 G
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 107
(Fuel tank temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION: H
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output SEF012P
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground. I
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C4A
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause J
P0182 Fuel tank temperature An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
● Harness or connectors
0182 sensor circuit low input sent to ECM.
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
P0183 Fuel tank temperature An excessively high voltage from the sensor is K
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
0183 sensor circuit high input sent to ECM.
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWH0109E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG F
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
G
2. CHECK DTC WITH “UNIFIED METER AND A/C AMP.”
Refer to DI-32, "SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS" .
H
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Go to DI-20, "Fuel Level Sensor Signal Inspection 1" .
I
3. CHECK FUEL TANK TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. J
2. Disconnect “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” harness con-
nector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON. K
M
PBIB1507E
4. Check voltage between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
terminal 4 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Approximately 5V
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0932E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connector.
5. CHECK FUEL TANK TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect “unified meter and A/C amp.” harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” terminal 5 and “unified meter and
A/C amp.” terminal 36. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
PBIB0931E
E
Removal and Installation ABS00C4F
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-945, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0428E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1480E
PBIB0082E
C
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
D
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 5 and ECM terminal 66. E
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
F
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. G
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT H
1. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 4 and ECM terminal 50.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
I
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG J
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
K
9. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-854, "Component Inspection" .
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
M
10. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next PBIB1530E
step.
7. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Removal and Installation ABS00C4N
When a misfire occurs, engine speed will fluctuate. If the engine speed fluctuates enough to cause the crank- EC
shaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) signal to vary, ECM can determine that a misfire is occurring.
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Engine speed On board diagnosis of misfire C
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle in safe manner according to traffic conditions and obey all traffic laws when driv-
ing.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
The similar conditions to (1st trip) Freeze Frame Data means the vehicle operation that the following con-
ditions should be satisfied at the same time.
Engine speed Engine speed in the freeze frame data ± 400 rpm
Vehicle speed Vehicle speed in the freeze frame data ± 10 km/h (6 MPH)
When the freeze frame data shows lower than 70 °C (158 °F),
Engine coolant temperature T should be lower than 70 °C (158 °F).
(T) condition When the freeze frame data shows higher than or equal to 70 °C (158 °F),
T should be higher than or equal to 70 °C (158 °F).
The time to driving varies according to the engine speed in the freeze frame data.
Engine speed Time
Around 1,000 rpm Approximately 10 minutes
Around 2,000 rpm Approximately 5 minutes
More than 3,000 rpm Approximately 3.5 minutes
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C4Q
PBIB0133E
E
Without CONSULT-II
When disconnecting each injector harness connector one at a time, is there any cylinder which does not pro-
duce a momentary engine speed drop? F
I
PBIB1518E
Yes or No J
Yes >> GO TO 4.
No >> GO TO 7.
K
4. CHECK INJECTOR
Does each injector make an operating sound at idle?
Yes or No L
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> Check injector(s) and circuit(s). Refer to EC-1274,
"INJECTOR CIRCUIT" . M
PBIB1986E
SEF575Q
SEF156I
>> GO TO 15.
PBIB0021E
E
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C4S
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at K
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
L
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II. M
2. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-957, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0241E
2. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
I
1. Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 15 and knock
sensor (bank1) terminal 1, ECM terminal 36 and knock sensor J
(bank 2) terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist. K
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
L
OK >> GO TO 4.
PBIB0021E
NG >> GO TO 3.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
KNOCK SENSOR A
Check resistance between knock sensor terminal 1 and ground.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more EC
than 10 MΩ.
Resistance: Approximately 532 - 588 kΩ [at 20°C (68°F)]
C
CAUTION:
Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or phys-
ically damaged. Use only new ones.
D
SEF111Y
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal
is not detected by the ECM during the first
few seconds of engine cranking.
● Harness or connectors
● The proper pulse signal from the crankshaft (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0335 Crankshaft position
position sensor (POS) is not sent to ECM
0335 sensor (POS) circuit ● Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
while the engine is running.
● Signal plate
● The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal
is not in the normal pattern during engine
running.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-962, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0242E
1.0 - 2.0V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1041E
Crankshaft position sensor
13 Y
(POS)
1.0 - 2.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1042E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1483E
SEF481Y
H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
4. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. M
2. Check harness continuity between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
PBIB0563E
PBIB0564E
D
Removal and Installation ABS00C55
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
● The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
for the first few seconds during engine
cranking. ● Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
P0340 Camshaft position sen- ● Camshaft (Exhaust)
● The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
0340 sor (PHASE) circuit
during engine running. ● Starter motor (Refer to SC-10 .)
● The cylinder No. signal is not in the normal ● Starting system circuit (Refer to SC-10 .)
pattern during engine running.
● Dead (Weak) battery
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-968, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Maintaining engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5
seconds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-968, "Diagnostic Procedure"
. SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0243E
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
idle
PBIB1039E
Camshaft position sensor
14 W
(PHASE)
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1040E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1499E
SEF481Y
H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. M
2. Check harness continuity between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 1 and ground.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
PBIB0563E
PBIB0564E
SEF484YF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0420 ● Three way catalyst (manifold) F
0420 ● Exhaust tube
(Bank 1) ● Three way catalyst (manifold) does not oper- ● Intake air leaks
Catalyst system effi- ate properly.
● Fuel injector G
P0430 ciency below threshold ● Three way catalyst (manifold) does not have
enough oxygen storage capacity. ● Fuel injector leaks
0430
(Bank 2) ● Spark plug
● Improper ignition timing H
NOTE: I
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II J
TESTING CONDITION:
Do not hold engine speed for more than the specified minutes below.
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with K
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture. L
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load. M
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C
(158°F). SEF189Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
7. Open engine hood.
SEF940Z
SEF941Z
SEF535Z
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the three way catalyst (manifold). During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
3. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
4. Open engine hood.
5. Set voltmeters probes between ECM terminals 16 [HO2S1
(bank 1) signal], 35 [HO2S1 (bank 2) signal] and ground, and
ECM terminals 55 [HO2S2 (bank 1) signal], 74 [HO2S2 (bank 2)
signal] and ground.
6. Keep engine speed at 2,000 rpm constant under no load.
PBIB1528E
SEC502D
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
M
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
5. CHECK INJECTORS
1. Stop engine and then turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 21, 22, 23, 40, 41, 42,
44, 63 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
Refer to Wiring Diagram for Injectors, EC-1275 .
Battery voltage should exist.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Perform EC-1276, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1527E
SEF575Q
NOTE:
If DTC P0441 is displayed with other DTC such as P2122, P2123, P2127, P2128 or P2138, first perform
trouble diagnosis for other DTC.
PBIB1026E
In this evaporative emission (EVAP) control system, purge flow occurs during non-closed throttle conditions.
Purge volume is related to air intake volume. Under normal purge conditions (non-closed throttle), the EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve is open to admit purge flow. Purge flow exposes the EVAP con-
trol system pressure sensor to intake manifold vacuum.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C5I
Under normal conditions (non-closed throttle), sensor output voltage indicates if pressure drop and purge flow
are adequate. If not, a malfunction is determined.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve stuck closed
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
and the circuit
● Loose, disconnected or improper con-
EVAP control system does not operate prop- nection of rubber tube
P0441 EVAP control system erly, EVAP control system has a leak between ● Blocked rubber tube
0441 incorrect purge flow intake manifold and EVAP control system pres-
● Cracked EVAP canister
sure sensor.
● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve circuit
● Accelerator pedal position sensor
● Blocked purge port
● EVAP canister vent control valve
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Always perform test at a temperature of 5°C (41°F) or more.
Revision: 2004 November EC-976 2004 FX35/FX45
DTC P0441 EVAP CONTROL SYSTEM
[VK45DE]
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. A
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 70 seconds.
EC
4. Select “PURG FLOW P0441” of “EVAPORATIVE SYSTEM” in “DTC CONFIRMATION” mode with CON-
SULT-II.
5. Touch “START”.
If “COMPLETED” is displayed, go to step 7. C
6. When the following conditions are met, “TESTING” will be displayed on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain
the conditions continuously until “TESTING” changes to “COMPLETED”. (It will take at least 35 seconds.)
D
Selector lever Suitable position
VHCL SPEED SE 32 - 120 km/h (20 - 75 MPH)
ENG SPEED 500 - 3,000 rpm E
B/FUEL SCHDL 1.0 - 10.0 msec
COOLAN TEMP/S 70 - 100°C (158 - 212°F)
F
I
PBIB0826E
G
SEF367U
SEF368U
K
6. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
With CONSULT-II L
1. Start engine.
2. Perform “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode with
CONSULT-II. Check that engine speed varies according to the M
valve opening.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
PBIB1678E
>> GO TO 14.
This diagnosis detects leaks in the EVAP purge line using engine intake manifold vacuum.
If pressure does not increase, the ECM will check for leaks in the line between the fuel tank and EVAP canister EC
purge volume control solenoid valve, under the following “Vacuum test” conditions.
The EVAP canister vent control valve is closed to shut the EVAP purge line off. The EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve will then be opened to depressurize the EVAP purge line using intake manifold
vacuum. After this occurs, the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve will be closed. C
PBIB1026E I
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Incorrect fuel tank vacuum relief valve J
● Incorrect fuel filler cap used
● Fuel filler cap remains open or fails to close.
● Foreign matter caught in fuel filler cap.
K
● Leak is in line between intake manifold and
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve. L
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister vent
control valve.
● EVAP canister or fuel tank leaks M
● EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube) leaks
EVAP control system EVAP control system has a leak, EVAP ● EVAP purge line rubber tube bent
P0442
small leak detected control system does not operate prop-
0442 ● Loose or disconnected rubber tube
(negative pressure) erly.
● EVAP canister vent control valve and the circuit
● EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve and the circuit
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
● O-ring of EVAP canister vent control valve is
missing or damaged
● EVAP canister is saturated with water
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Fuel level sensor and the circuit
● Refueling EVAP vapor cut valve
● ORVR system leaks
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” when the fuel level is between 1/4 and 3/4 full, and vehicle is
placed on flat level surface.
● Always perform test at a temperature of 0 to 30°C (32 to 86°F).
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that the following conditions are met.
COOLAN TEMP/S: 0 - 70°C (32 - 158°F)
INT/A TEMP SE: 0 - 30°C (32 - 86°F)
5. Select “EVAP SML LEAK P0442/P1442” of “EVAPORATIVE SYSTEM” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode
with CONSULT-II.
Follow the instruction displayed.
PBIB0829E
NOTE:
If the engine speed cannot be maintained within the range displayed on the CONSULT-II screen, go to
EC-733, "Basic Inspection" .
SEC763C
WITH GST
NOTE:
Be sure to read the explanation of EC-713, "Driving Pattern" before driving vehicle.
1. Start engine.
2. Drive vehicle according to EC-713, "Driving Pattern" .
SEF915U G
Check for air releasing sound while opening the fuel filler cap.
OK or NG K
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
L
4. CHECK FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE
Refer to EC-1323, "FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FULLER CAP)" .
OK or NG M
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace fuel filler cap with a genuine one.
PBIB1479E
SEF916U
NOTE:
Improper installation of the EVAP service port adapter to the EVAP service port may cause leaking.
With CONSULT-II>>GO TO 6.
Without CONSULT-II>>GO TO 7.
PEF917U
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak F
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details.
Refer to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAW-
ING" . G
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace. H
SEF200U
I
PBIB1522E
3. Pressurize the EVAP line using pressure pump with 1.3 to 2.7 kPa (10 to 20 mmHg, 0.39 to 0.79 inHg),
then remove pump and EVAP service port adapter.
NOTE:
● Never use compressed air or a high pressure pump.
Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in the system.
●
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details. Refer
to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF200U
PBIB1031E E
PBIB1678E
>> GO TO 20.
Check recirculation line between filler neck tube and fuel tank for clogging, kink, cracks, looseness and
improper connection. D
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 22.
NG >> Repair or replace hose, tube or filler neck tube. E
Description ABS00C5P
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Engine speed*1
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
SEF337U
A
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
EVAP canister purge volume (The solenoid valve circuit is open or
P0444 An excessively low voltage signal is sent EC
control solenoid valve circuit shorted.)
0444 to ECM through the valve
open ● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
C
● Harness or connectors
EVAP canister purge volume (The solenoid valve circuit is shorted.)
P0445 An excessively high voltage signal is sent
control solenoid valve circuit
0445 to ECM through the valve ● EVAP canister purge volume control
shorted D
solenoid valve
NOTE: E
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: F
Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. G
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 13 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-994, "Diagnostic Procedure" H
.
SEF058Y
K
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
L
TBWM0246E
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More G
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
PBIB0051E H
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch: OFF]
0 - 1.5V
● For a few seconds after turning ignition I
ECM relay switch OFF
111 W/B
(Self shut-off)
[Ignition switch: OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● More than a few seconds after turning igni- J
(11 - 14V)
tion switch OFF
119 R BATTERY VOLTAGE
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch: ON]
120 R (11 - 14V) K
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
1. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB1478E
PBIB0148E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 45 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 4.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1678E
PBIB0149E
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Air passage continuity
Condition
between A and B
12V direct current supply between
Yes
terminals 1 and 2
No supply No
PBIB0150E
The EVAP canister vent control valve is located on the EVAP canis-
ter and is used to seal the canister vent. EC
This solenoid valve responds to signals from the ECM. When the
ECM sends an ON signal, the coil in the solenoid valve is energized.
A plunger will then move to seal the canister vent. The ability to seal
the vent is necessary for the on board diagnosis of other evaporative C
emission control system components.
This solenoid valve is used only for diagnosis, and usually remains
opened. D
When the vent is closed, under normal purge conditions, the evapo-
rative emission control system is depressurized and allows “EVAP
PBIB1263E
Control System” diagnosis.
E
H
PBIB1522E
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 8 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1000, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWH0110E
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
PBIB0151E
PBIB1522E
E
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EVAP canister vent control valve termi-
nal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester. F
PBIB0152E
I
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following. J
● Harness connectors E211, M41
● Harness connectors M11, B1
● Harness connectors B84, B216 K
● IPDM E/R harness connector E7
● 10A fuse
L
● Harness for open or short between EVAP canister vent control valve and IPDM E/R
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. M
5. CHECK EVAP CANISTER VENT CONTROL VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 117 and EVAP canister vent control valve terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1033E
D
7. Clean the air passage (portion A to B ) of EVAP canister vent control valve using an air blower.
8. Perform step 6 again.
Without CONSULT-II E
1. Remove EVAP canister vent control valve from EVAP canister.
2. Check portion B of EVAP canister vent control valve for being
rusted. F
PBIB1033E
I
3. Check air passage continuity and operation delay time under the
following conditions.
Make sure new O-ring is installed properly.
J
Condition Air passage continuity between A and B
12V direct current supply between
No
terminals 1 and 2 K
OFF Yes
Operation takes less than 1 second.
L
If NG, replace EVAP canister vent control valve. PBIB1034E
The EVAP control system pressure sensor detects pressure in the purge line. The sensor output voltage to the
ECM increases as pressure increases.
PBIB1522E
PBIB1207E
NOTE:
If DTC P0451 is displayed with DTC P1229, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1229. Refer to
EC-1156 .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
EVAP control system ● Harness or connectors
P0451 ECM detects a sloshing signal from the EVAP
pressure sensor perfor-
0451 control system pressure sensor ● EVAP control system pressure sensor
mance
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with C
CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 40 seconds.
NOTE: D
Do not depress accelerator pedal even slightly.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1005, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
E
SEF194Y
F
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above. G
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C68
L
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
M
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1522E
CAUTION:
● Always calibrate the vacuum pump gauge when using it.
● Do not apply below -93.3 kPa (-700 mmHg, -27.56 inHg) or PBIB1173E
pressure over 101.3 kPa (760 mmHg, 29.92 inHg).
4. If NG, replace EVAP control system pressure sensor.
The EVAP control system pressure sensor detects pressure in the purge line. The sensor output voltage to the
ECM increases as pressure increases. EC
E
PBIB1522E
PBIB1207E I
NOTE:
If DTC P0452 is displayed with DTC P1229, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1229. Refer to L
EC-1156 .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause M
EVAP control system ● Harness or connectors
P0452 An excessively low voltage from the sensor is (The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
pressure sensor low
0452 sent to ECM.
input ● EVAP control system pressure sensor
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Always perform test at a temperature of 5°C (41°F) or more.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Make sure that “FUEL T/TEMP SE” is more than 0°C (32°F).
6. Start engine and wait at least 20 seconds.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1010, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF194Y
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check that voltage between ECM terminal 107 (Fuel tank tem-
perature sensor signal) and ground is less than 4.2V.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and wait at least 20 seconds.
5. Select MODE 7 with GST.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1010, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
PBIB1110E
EC
TBWH0115E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
EC
PBIB1522E
K
PBIB0138E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK EVAP CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 32 and EVAP control system pressure sensor terminal
2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
CAUTION:
● Always calibrate the vacuum pump gauge when using it.
G
● Do not apply below -93.3 kPa (-700 mmHg, -27.56 inHg) or PBIB1173E
pressure over 101.3 kPa (760 mmHg, 29.92 inHg).
4. If NG, replace EVAP control system pressure sensor. H
The EVAP control system pressure sensor detects pressure in the purge line. The sensor output voltage to the
ECM increases as pressure increases.
PBIB1522E
PBIB1207E
NOTE:
If DTC P0453 is displayed with DTC P1229, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1229. Refer to
EC-1156 .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Always perform test at a temperature of 5°C (41°F) or more.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. C
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
D
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Make sure that “FUEL T/TEMP SE” is more than 0°C (32°F).
6. Wait at least 10 seconds. E
7. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1017, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
F
G
SEF194Y
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. H
2. Check that voltage between ECM terminal 107 (Fuel tank tem-
perature sensor signal) and ground is less than 4.2V.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. I
4. Wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Select MODE 7 with GST.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1017, "Diagnostic Proce- J
dure" .
K
PBIB1110E
TBWH0115E
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground. A
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
EC
TER-
WIRE
MINAL ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
COLOR
NO.
C
EVAP control system pres-
32 OR [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 1.8 - 4.8V
sure sensor
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor / D
48 L [Ignition switch: ON] Approximately 5V
EVAP control system pres-
sure sensor)
Sensor ground E
(Mass air flow sensor / IAT
sensor / Power steering [Engine is running]
67 B/W pressure sensor / EVAP ● Warm-up condition Approximately 0V
control system pressure ● Idle speed
F
sensor / Refrigerant pres-
sure sensor / ECT sensor)
PBIB2195E
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections. M
PBIB1522E
PBIB0138E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
H
7. CHECK EVAP CONTROL SYSTEM PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
I
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 32 and EVAP control system pressure sensor terminal
2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
J
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
K
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
L
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following. M
● Harness connectors B201, M81
● Harness connectors M82, F102
● Harness for open or short between EVAP control system pressure sensor and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1031E
CAUTION:
● Always calibrate the vacuum pump gauge when using it. E
● Do not apply below -93.3 kPa (-700 mmHg, -27.56 inHg) or PBIB1173E
pressure over 101.3 kPa (760 mmHg, 29.92 inHg).
4. If NG, replace EVAP control system pressure sensor. F
This diagnosis detects a very large leak (fuel filler cap fell off etc.) in EVAP system between the fuel tank and
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
PBIB1026E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Fuel filler cap remains open or fails to
close.
● Incorrect fuel tank vacuum relief valve
● Incorrect fuel filler cap used
● Foreign matter caught in fuel filler cap.
● Leak is in line between intake manifold
and EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve.
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister
vent control valve.
● EVAP canister or fuel tank leaks
EVAP control system has a very large leak ● EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube)
P0455 EVAP control system leaks
such as fuel filler cap fell off, EVAP control sys-
0455 gross leak detected
tem does not operate properly. ● EVAP purge line rubber tube bent.
● Loose or disconnected rubber tube
● EVAP canister vent control valve and the
circuit
● EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve and the circuit
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
● O-ring of EVAP canister vent control
valve is missing or damaged.
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Refueling EVAP vapor cut valve
● ORVR system leaks
CAUTION:
● Use only a genuine NISSAN fuel filler cap as a replacement. If an incorrect fuel filler cap is used,
the MIL may come on.
● If the fuel filler cap is not tightened properly, the MIL may come on.
CAUTION:
Never remove fuel filler cap during the DTC Confirmation Procedure. EC
NOTE:
● Make sure that EVAP hoses are connected to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
properly.
C
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
D
● Perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” when the fuel level is between 1/4 and 3/4 full, and vehicle is
placed on flat level surface.
● Open engine hood before conducting the following procedures. E
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Tighten fuel filler cap securely until ratcheting sound is heard.
2. Turn ignition switch ON. F
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
G
5. Make sure that the following conditions are met.
COOLAN TEMP/S: 0 - 70°C (32 - 158°F)
INT/A TEMP SE: 0 - 60°C (32 - 140°F)
6. Select “EVAP SML LEAK P0442/P1442” of “EVAPORATIVE SYSTEM” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode H
with CONSULT-II.
Follow the instruction displayed.
I
PBIB0829E L
NOTE:
If the engine speed cannot be maintained within the range displayed on the CONSULT-II screen, go to
EC-733, "Basic Inspection" . M
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed.
If “NG” is displayed, select “SELF-DIAG RESULTS” mode and
make sure that “EVAP GROSS LEAK [P0455]” is displayed. If it
is displayed, refer to EC-1024, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If P0442 is displayed, perform Diagnostic Procedure for DTC
P0442 EC-983, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC763C
SEF915U
>> GO TO 7.
E
7. CHECK EVAP CANISTER VENT CONTROL VALVE
Check the following. F
● EVAP canister vent control valve is installed properly.
Refer to EC-1324, "Removal and Installation" .
● EVAP canister vent control valve. G
Refer to EC-1002, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. H
NG >> Repair or replace EVAP canister vent control valve and O-ring.
L
PBIB1479E
SEF916U
With CONSULT-II>>GO TO 9.
Without CONSULT-II>>GO TO 10.
PEF917U
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details.
Refer to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAW-
ING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF200U
PBIB1522E
F
3. Pressurize the EVAP line using pressure pump with 1.3 to 2.7 kPa (10 to 20 mmHg, 0.39 to 0.79 inHg),
then remove pump and EVAP service port adapter.
NOTE:
● Do not use compressed air or a high pressure pump. G
Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in the system.
●
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak H
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details. Refer
to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
I
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair or replace.
J
SEF200U
K
11. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II L
1. Disconnect vacuum hose to EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve at EVAP service port.
2. Start engine.
M
3. Perform “PURG VOL CONT/V” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode.
4. Touch “Qu” on CONSULT-II screen to increase “PURG VOL
CONT/V” opening to 100%.
5. Check vacuum hose for vacuum when revving engine up to
2,000 rpm.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
PBIB0828E
PBIB0828E
This diagnosis detects very small leaks in the EVAP line between fuel tank and EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve, using the intake manifold vacuum in the same way as conventional EVAP small leak
diagnosis.
If ECM judges a leak which corresponds to a very small leak, the very small leak P0456 will be detected.
If ECM judges a leak equivalent to a small leak, EVAP small leak P0442 will be detected.
If ECM judges there are no leaks, the diagnosis will be OK.
PBIB1026E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Incorrect fuel tank vacuum relief valve
● Incorrect fuel filler cap used
● Fuel filler cap remains open or fails to close.
● Foreign matter caught in fuel filler cap.
● Leak is in line between intake manifold and EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister vent con-
trol valve.
● EVAP canister or fuel tank leaks
● EVAP purge line (pipe and rubber tube) leaks
● EVAP purge line rubber tube bent
Evaporative emission ● EVAP system has a very small leak. ● Loose or disconnected rubber tube
P0456 control system very
0456 small leak (negative ● EVAP system does not operate prop- ● EVAP canister vent control valve and the circuit
pressure check) erly. ● EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve and the circuit
● Fuel tank temperature sensor
● O-ring of EVAP canister vent control valve is miss-
ing or damaged
● EVAP canister is saturated with water
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● Refueling EVAP vapor cut valve
● ORVR system leaks
● Fuel level sensor and the circuit
● Foreign matter caught in EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve
NOTE: C
● If DTC P0456 is displayed with P0442, first perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0456.
● After repair, make sure that the hoses and clips are installed properly.
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait D
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Open engine hood before conducting following procedure. E
● If any of following conditions are met just before the DTC confirmation procedure, leave the vehi-
cle for more than 1 hour.
– Fuel filler cap is removed. F
– Fuel is refilled or drained.
– EVAP component parts is/are removed.
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle. G
PBIB0837E
WITH GST
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the EVAP very small leak function. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
CAUTION:
● Do not use compressed air, doing so may damage the EVAP system.
● Do not start engine.
● Do not exceeded 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi).
1. Attach the EVAP service port adapter securely to the EVAP ser-
vice port.
PBIB1479E
SEF915U
Check that the cap is tightened properly by rotating the cap clockwise.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> 1. Open fuel filler cap, then clean cap and fuel filler neck threads using air blower.
2. Retighten until ratcheting sound is heard.
PBIB1479E
SEF916U
NOTE:
Improper installation of the EVAP service port adapter to the EVAP service port may cause leaking.
With CONSULT-II>>GO TO 6.
Without CONSULT-II>>GO TO 7.
PEF917U
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak F
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details.
Refer to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAW-
ING" . G
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace. H
SEF200U
I
PBIB1522E
3. Pressurize the EVAP line using pressure pump with 1.3 to 2.7 kPa (10 to 20 mmHg, 0.39 to 0.79 inHg),
then remove pump and EVAP service port adapter.
NOTE:
● Do not use compressed air or a high pressure pump.
Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in the system.
●
4. Using EVAP leak detector, locate the EVAP leak. For the leak
detector, refer to the instruction manual for more details. Refer
to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF200U
PBIB1031E E
PBIB0147E
>> GO TO 20.
Check recirculation line between filler neck tube and fuel tank for clogging, kink, cracks, looseness and
improper connection. D
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 22.
NG >> Repair or replace hose, tube or filler neck tube. E
The fuel level sensor is mounted in the fuel level sensor unit. The
sensor detects a fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits a signal to
the “unified meter and A/C amp.”. The “unified meter and A/C amp.”
sends the fuel level sensor signal to the ECM through CAN commu-
nication line.
It consists of two parts, one is mechanical float and the other is vari-
able resistor. Fuel level sensor output voltage changes depending on
the movement of the fuel mechanical float.
PBIB1508E
NOTE:
If DTC P0460 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792 .
When the vehicle is parked, naturally the fuel level in the fuel tank is stable. It means that output signal of the
fuel level sensor does not change. If ECM senses sloshing signal from the sensor, fuel level sensor malfunc-
tion is detected.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
Even though the vehicle is parked, a signal
P0460 Fuel level sensor circuit ● Harness or connectors
being varied is sent from the fuel level sensor
0460 noise
to ECM. (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● Fuel level sensor
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait maximum of 2 consecutive minutes.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1041, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF195Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
The fuel level sensor is mounted in the fuel level sensor unit. The
sensor detects a fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits a signal to
the “unified meter and A/C amp.”. The “unified meter and A/C amp.”
sends the fuel level sensor signal to the ECM through CAN commu-
nication line.
It consists of two parts, one is mechanical float and the other is vari-
able resistor. Fuel level sensor output voltage changes depending on
the movement of the fuel mechanical float.
PBIB1508E
NOTE:
If DTC P0461 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792 .
Driving long distances naturally affect fuel gauge level.
This diagnosis detects the fuel gauge malfunction of the gauge not moving even after a long distance has
been driven.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
The output signal of the fuel level sensor does shorted)
P0461 Fuel level sensor circuit not change within the specified range even ● Harness or connectors
0461 range/performance though the vehicle has been driven a long dis-
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
tance.
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● Fuel level sensor
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the fuel level sensor function. During this check, a 1st trip
DTC might not be confirmed.
WARNING:
When performing following procedure, be sure to observe the handling of the fuel. Refer to FL-10,
"FUEL TANK" .
TESTING CONDITION:
Before starting overall function check, preparation of draining fuel and refilling fuel is required.
WITH CONSULT-II
NOTE:
Start from step 10, if it is possible to confirm that the fuel cannot be drained by 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/
8 Imp gal) in advance.
1. Prepare a fuel container and a spare hose.
2. Release fuel pressure from fuel line, refer to EC-700, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
3. Remove the fuel feed hose on the fuel level sensor unit.
4. Connect a spare fuel hose where the fuel feed hose was removed.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds then turn ON.
6. Select “FUEL LEVEL SE” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
WITH GST
NOTE: E
Start from step 8, if it is possible to confirm that the fuel cannot be drained by 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/8
Imp gal) in advance.
1. Prepare a fuel container and a spare hose.
F
2. Release fuel pressure from fuel line. Refer to EC-700, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
3. Remove the fuel feed hose on the fuel level sensor unit.
4. Connect a spare fuel hose where the fuel feed hose was removed. G
5. Turn ignition switch ON.
6. Drain fuel by 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/8 Imp gal) from the fuel tank using proper equipment.
7. Confirm that the fuel gauge indication varies. H
8. Fill fuel into the fuel tank for 30 (7-7/8 US gal, 6-5/8 Imp gal).
9. Confirm that the fuel gauge indication varies.
I
10. If NG, go to EC-1043, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C73
The fuel level sensor is mounted in the fuel level sensor unit. The
sensor detects a fuel level in the fuel tank and transmits a signal to
the “unified meter and A/C amp.”. The “unified meter and A/C amp.”
sends the fuel level sensor signal to the ECM through CAN commu-
nication line.
It consists of two parts, one is mechanical float and the other is vari-
able resistor. Fuel level sensor output voltage changes depending on
the movement of the fuel mechanical float.
PBIB1508E
NOTE:
If DTC P0462 or P0463 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for
DTC U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-792 .
This diagnosis indicates the former, to detect open or short circuit malfunction.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0462 Fuel level sensor circuit An excessively low voltage from the sensor is ● Harness or connectors
0462 low input sent to ECM. (The CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
● Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
P0463 Fuel level sensor circuit An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
0463 high input sent to ECM. ● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● Fuel level sensor
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at ignition
switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1045, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF195Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Description ABS00C7A
NOTE:
If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the “unified meter and A/C amp.” from the “ABS actuator and electric unit
(control unit)” by CAN communication line. The “unified meter and A/C amp.” then sends a signal to the ECM
by CAN communication line.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C7B
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 1 and 2 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine (VDC switch OFF).
2. Read “VHCL SPEED SE” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. The vehicle speed on CONSULT-
II should exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
If NG, go to EC-1047, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Warm engine up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
ENG SPEED 1,600 - 6,000 rpm
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70°C (158°F)
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 4.5 msec
Selector lever Except P or N position
PW/ST SIGNAL OFF
A
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the vehicle speed sensor circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST EC
1. Lift up drive wheels.
2. Start engine.
3. Read vehicle speed sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST. C
The vehicle speed sensor on GST should be able to exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with
suitable gear position.
4. If NG, go to EC-1047, "Diagnostic Procedure" . D
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C7E
1. CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)” E
Refer to BRC-12, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. F
NG >> Repair or replace.
Description ABS00C7F
NOTE:
If DTC P0506 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for the other DTC.
The ECM controls the engine idle speed to a specified level through the fine adjustment of the air, which is let
into the intake manifold, by operating the electric throttle control actuator. The operating of the throttle valve is
varied to allow for optimum control of the engine idling speed. The crankshaft position sensor (POS) detects
the actual engine speed and sends a signal to the ECM.
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator so that the engine speed coincides with the target value
memorized in the ECM. The target engine speed is the lowest speed at which the engine can operate steadily.
The optimum value stored in the ECM is determined by taking into consideration various engine conditions,
such as during warming up, deceleration, and engine load (air conditioner, power steering and cooling fan
operation, etc.).
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C7G
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
Idle speed control sys- ● Electric throttle control actuator
P0506 The idle speed is less than the target idle
tem RPM lower than
0506 speed by 100 rpm or more. ● Intake air leak
expected
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● If the target idle speed is out of the specified value, perform Idle Air Volume Learning, EC-698 ,
before conducting DTC Confirmation Procedure. For the target idle speed, refer to the EC-1336,
"SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)" .
TESTING CONDITION:
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
● Always perform the test at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Open engine hood.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON again and select “DATA MONITOR”
mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 1 minute at idle speed.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1049, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
2. REPLACE ECM
D
1. Stop engine.
2. Replace ECM.
3. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to BL-208, "ECM E
Re-communicating Function" .
4. Perform EC-698, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" . F
6. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Description ABS00C7J
NOTE:
If DTC P0507 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for the other DTC.
The ECM controls the engine idle speed to a specified level through the fine adjustment of the air, which is let
into the intake manifold, by operating the electric throttle control actuator. The operating of the throttle valve is
varied to allow for optimum control of the engine idling speed. The crankshaft position sensor (POS) detects
the actual engine speed and sends a signal to the ECM.
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator so that the engine speed coincides with the target value
memorized in the ECM. The target engine speed is the lowest speed at which the engine can operate steadily.
The optimum value stored in the ECM is determined by taking into consideration various engine conditions,
such as during warming up, deceleration, and engine load (air conditioner, power steering and cooling fan
operation, etc.).
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C7K
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● If the target idle speed is out of the specified value, perform Idle Air Volume Learning, EC-698 ,
before conducting DTC Confirmation Procedure. For the target idle speed, refer to the EC-1336,
"SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)" .
TESTING CONDITION:
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
● Always perform the test at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Open engine hood.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON again and select “DATA MONITOR”
mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 1 minute at idle speed.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1051, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF174Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
3. REPLACE ECM
F
1. Stop engine.
2. Replace ECM.
3. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to BL-208, "ECM G
Re-communicating Function" .
4. Perform EC-698, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" . H
6. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
I
>> INSPECTION END
PBIB1484E
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1054, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0249E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1484E
PBIB0188E H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground short to power in harness or connectors.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned. 0.5 - 4.5V
Steering wheel is not being turned. 0.4 - 0.8V
MBIB0126E
PBIB1164E
E
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C7W
FAIL-SAFE MODE H
ECM enters fail-safe mode when the malfunction A is detected.
Detected items Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
I
● ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5
Malfunction A degrees) by the return spring.
● ECM deactivates ASCD operation.
J
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS00C7X
Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be confirmed, perform
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B. If there is no malfunction on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION K
B, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at L
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
M
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1058, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn
ON.
4. Repeat step 3 for 32 times.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1058, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C7Y
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “SELF DIAG RESULTS” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch “ERASE”.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1057, "DTC Confirmation Procedure" .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select MODE 4 with GST.
3. Touch “ERASE”.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1057, "DTC Confirmation Procedure" .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
Battery voltage is supplied to the ECM even when the ignition switch
is turned OFF for the ECM memory function of the DTC memory, the
air-fuel ratio feedback compensation value memory, the idle air vol-
ume learning value memory, etc.
PBIB1164E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
P1065 ECM power supply cir- ECM back-up RAM system does not function [ECM power supply (back-up) circuit is
1065 cuit properly. open or shorted.]
● ECM
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn
ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for 4 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1062, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0250E
MBIB0026E
5. REPLACE ECM
H
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to BL-208, "ECM
Re-communicating Function" .
I
3. Perform EC-698, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" . J
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
SEC266C
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II. C
3. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1067, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
D
SEF058Y
F
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
G
TBWM0225E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1502E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
● Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation ABS00C8B
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1111
1111 ● Harness or connectors
(Bank 1) An improper voltage is sent to the ECM (Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
Intake valve timing control
through intake valve timing control solenoid circuit is open or shorted.)
P1136 solenoid valve circuit
valve.
1136 ● Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
(Bank 2)
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1074, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Following the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0219E
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
10 OR
solenoid valve (bank 1) [Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1790E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
EC
TBWM0220E
7 - 12V
Intake valve timing control
11 BR
solenoid valve (bank 2) [Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB1790E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
1. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
PBIB1517E
PBIB0192E
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR
OPEN AND SHORT D
PBIB0193E
Electric throttle control actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve. EC
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve position, and the opening and closing speed of the throt-
tle valve and feeds the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle
valve from these signals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening
angle properly in response to driving condition. C
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
Electric throttle control actuator does not func- E
A) tion properly due to the return spring malfunc-
tion.
P1121 Electric throttle control
● Electric throttle control actuator
1121 actuator Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
B) F
not in specified range.
C) ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.
G
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode H
The ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the idle position.
Malfunction A
The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
Malfunction B ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20 degrees or less. I
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the engine stalls.
Malfunction C
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or more.
J
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS00C8M
NOTE:
● Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B first. If the DTC cannot be confirmed, perform K
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test. L
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second. M
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position and wait at least 3 seconds.
4. Shift selector lever to P position.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
7. Shift selector lever to D position and wait at least 3 seconds.
8. Shift selector lever to P position.
9. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn
ON.
SEF058Y
10. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1078, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C8N
PBIB1494E
NOTE:
If DTC P1122 is displayed with DTC P1121 or 1126, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1121 or EC
P1126. Refer to EC-1077 or EC-1085 .
Electric throttle control actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed- C
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
D
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C8P
● Harness or connectors
P1122 Electric throttle control Electric throttle control function does not oper- (Throttle control motor circuit is open or
1122 performance problem ate properly. shorted) F
● Electric throttle control actuator
FAIL-SAFE MODE G
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
H
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0251E
0 - 14V D
[Ignition switch: ON]
Throttle control motor ● Engine stopped
4 L/W E
(Close) ● Shift lever: D
● Accelerator pedal is released
PBIB1104E F
0 - 14V
BATTERY VOLTAGE
[Ignition switch: OFF] I
104 L/OR Throttle control motor relay (11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch: ON] 0 - 1.0V
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1171E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
8. CHECK FUSE
1. Disconnect 15A fuse. H
2. Check 15A fuse for blown.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9. I
NG >> Replace 15A fuse.
PBIB1494E
PBIB0095E
Power supply for the throttle control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends EC
an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
provided to the ECM.
C
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00C8W
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at L
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1124
M
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1088, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
With GST
Follow the procedure “With CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0252E
PBIB1171E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00C92
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1092, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0253E
0 - 14V
PBIB1104E
0 - 14V
PBIB1105E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB0095E
Intake valve timing control position sensors are located in the front of
cylinder heads in both bank 1 and bank 2. EC
This sensor uses a Hall IC.
The cam position is determined by the intake primary cam sprocket
concave (in four places). The ECM provides feedback to the intake
valve timing control for appropriate target valve open-close timing C
according to drive conditions based on detected cam position.
SEF359Z
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00C99
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1140 ● Harness or connectors I
1140 (Intake valve timing control position
(bank 1) sensor circuit is open or shorted)
● Intake valve timing control position
Intake valve timing control An excessively high or low voltage from the J
sensor
P1145 position sensor circuit sensor is sent to ECM.
● Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
1145
(bank 2) ● Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
K
● Accumulation of debris to the signal
pick-up portion of the camshaft
BANK 1
TBWM0244E
F
PBIB2046E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
G
TBWM0245E
F
PBIB2046E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
G
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C9D
L
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2. M
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1517E
SEF509Y
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between intake valve timing control position sensor terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
SEF362Z
PBIB0194E
SEF463R
H
SEF288D
SEF300U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1143 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
1143 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
(Bank 1) The maximum and minimum voltage from the
Heated oxygen sensor
sensor are not reached to the specified volt- ● Fuel pressure
P1163 1 lean shift monitoring
ages. ● Fuel injector
1163
(Bank 2) ● Intake air leaks
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Always perform at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
● Before performing following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “HO2S1 (B1) P1143” of “HO2S1” or “HO2S1 (B2) P1163” of “HO2S1”
in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch “START”.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not raise engine speed above 3,000 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
PBIB0546E
step 2.
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG
RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-1105, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
SEC769C
A
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST EC
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1(B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and
ground. C
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
– The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least 1 time. D
– The minimum voltage is over 0.1V at least 1 time.
4. If NG, go to EC-1105, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
E
F
PBIB1528E
PBIB2195E
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
M
PBIB1520E
>> GO TO 3.
SEF968Y
With GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected? PBIB1502E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174. Refer to EC-914 .
No >> GO TO 4.
SEF646Y M
6. Check the following.
● “HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2)” in “DATA MONITOR” mode
changes from “RICH” to “LEAN” to “RICH” more than 5 times
in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
● “HO2S1 (B1)/(B2)” voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least 1 time.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation ABS00C9N
SEF463R
H
SEF288D
SEF299U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1144
1144 ● Heated oxygen sensor 1
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor The maximum and minimum voltages from the ● Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
P1164 1 rich shift monitoring sensor are beyond the specified voltages. ● Fuel pressure
1164 ● Fuel injector
(Bank 2)
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Always perform at a temperature above −10°C (14°F).
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “HO2S1 (B1) P1144” or “HO2S1 (B2) P1164” of “HO2S1” in “DTC
WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch “START”.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Do not raise engine speed above 3,000 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
PBIB0548E
step 2.
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG
RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-1111, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
SEC772C
A
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST EC
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1(B1) signal] 35 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm C
constant under no load.
– The maximum voltage is below 0.8V at least 1 time.
– The minimum voltage is below 0.35V at least 1 time. D
4. If NG, go to EC-1111, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB1528E F
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00C9T
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
L
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1520E
>> GO TO 3.
Revision: 2004 November EC-1111 2004 FX35/FX45
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1
[VK45DE]
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select “SELF-LEARNING CONT” in “WORK SUPPORT” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching “CLEAR”.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
SEF968Y
With GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected? PBIB1502E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-923 .
No >> GO TO 4.
PBIB1521E
E
3. Check connectors for water.
Water should not exist. F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors. G
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
● Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 35 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
● The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
● The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least 1 time.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
SEF972Z
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1146 ● Harness or connectors
1146 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor
The minimum voltage from the sensor is not ● Heated oxygen sensor 2
2 minimum voltage
P1166 reached to the specified voltage.
monitoring ● Fuel pressure
1166
(Bank 2) ● Fuel injector
A
NOTE:
If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
For better results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
C
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera- D
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and E
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C F
(158°F). SEF174Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
G
7. Open engine hood.
8. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P1146” or “HO2S2 (B2) P1166” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
H
9. Start engine and following the instruction of CONSULT-II.
PBIB0818E
10. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”. L
If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-1122, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If “CAN NOT BE DIAGNOSED” is displayed, perform the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
M
b. Return to step 1.
Overall Function Check ABS00CA0
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 55 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 74 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
BANK 1 A
EC
TBWM0230E
EC
TBWM0231E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
E
SEF968Y
With GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. F
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
G
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
H
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
I
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected? PBIB1502E
J
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-923 .
K
No >> GO TO 3.
PBIB1534E
SEF174Y
I
6. Select “FUEL INJECTION” in “ACTIVE TEST” mode, and select
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
J
L
SEF662Y
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%. M
PBIB1624E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.62V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CA6
PBIB1625E
L
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1147 ● Harness or connectors
M
1147 (The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
(Bank 1) Heated oxygen sensor ● Heated oxygen sensor 2
The maximum voltage from the sensor is not
2 maximum voltage
P1167 reached to the specified voltage. ● Fuel pressure
monitoring
1167 ● Fuel injector
(Bank 2)
● Intake air leaks
NOTE:
If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
For better results, perform “DTC WORK SUPPORT” at a temperature of 0 to 30 °C (32 to 86 °F).
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and
4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
5. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
6. Make sure that “COOLAN TEMP/S” indicates more than 70°C
(158°F). SEF174Y
If not, warm up engine and go to next step when “COOLAN
TEMP/S” indication reaches to 70°C (158°F).
7. Open engine hood.
8. Select “HO2S2 (B1) P1147” or “HO2S2 (B2) P1167” of “HO2S2” in “DTC WORK SUPPORT” mode with
CONSULT-II.
9. Start engine and following the instruction of CONSULT-II.
PBIB0819E
10. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”.
If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-1133, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If “CAN NOT BE DIAGNOSED” is displayed, perform the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF and leave the vehicle in a cool place (soak the vehicle).
b. Return to step 1.
Overall Function Check ABS00CA9
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and keep the engine speed between 3,500 and 4,000 rpm for at least 1 minute under no load.
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 55 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 74 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
BANK 1
TBWM0230E
TBWM0231E
K
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
L
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
SEF968Y
With GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-715, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected? PBIB1502E
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174. Refer to EC-914 .
No >> GO TO 3.
PBIB1534E
E
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ECM terminal 78.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. F
SEF174Y
SEF662Y
7. Check “HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” at idle speed when adjusting “FUEL INJECTION” to ±25%.
PBIB1624E
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be above 0.62V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is +25%.
“HO2S2 (B1)/(B2)” should be below 0.48V at least once when the “FUEL INJECTION” is −25%.
CAUTION:
● Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
● Do not raise engine speed above 3,000 rpm during the DTC Confirmation Procedure. If the engine
speed limit is exceeded, retry the procedure from step 2.
● Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm and check one of the following.
– “HO2S1 (B1)/(B2)” voltage should go above 0.70V at least once.
– “HO2S1 (B1)/(B2)” voltage should go below 0.21V at least once.
If the check result is NG, perform EC-1139, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
If the check result is OK, perform the following step.
4. Let engine idle at least 5 minutes.
5. Maintain the following condition at least 50 consecutive sec-
onds.
SEC011C
B/FUEL SCHDL 4.0 msec or more
ENG SPEED More than 1,300 rpm
Selector lever Suitable position
VHCL SPEED SE More than 70 km/h (43 MPH)
During this test, P0132 and/or P0152 may be displayed on CONSULT-II screen.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1139, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
A
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the closed loop control. During this check, a DTC might not
be confirmed.
WITH GST EC
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S1 (B1)
signal] or 35 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and ground. C
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
– The voltage should go above 0.70V at least once. D
– The voltage should go below 0.21V at least once.
4. If NG, go to EC-1139, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
E
PBIB1528E
Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0133, P0153. Refer to EC-878, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G
Description ABS00CAI
The malfunction information related to TCS is transferred through the CAN communication line from “ABS
actuator and electric unit (control unit)” to ECM.
Be sure to erase the malfunction information such as DTC not only for “ABS actuator and electric unit
(control unit)” but also for ECM after TCS related repair.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00CAJ
Freeze frame data is not stored in the ECM for this self-diagnosis. The MIL will not light up for this self-
diagnosis.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● ABS actuator and electric unit (control
P1211 ECM receives a malfunction information from unit)
TCS control unit
1211 “ABS actuator electric unit (control unit)”
● TCS related parts
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 60 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1140, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00CAL
NOTE:
If DTC P1212 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000, EC
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
This CAN communication line is used to control the smooth engine operation during the TCS operation. Pulse
signals are exchanged between ECM and “ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)”.
Be sure to erase the malfunction information such as DTC not only for “ABS actuator and electric unit C
(control unit)” but also for ECM after TCS related repair.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00CAN
D
Freeze frame data is not stored in the ECM for this self-diagnosis. The MIL will not light up for this self-
diagnosis.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
E
● Harness or connectors
ECM can not receive the information (The CAN communication line is open or
P1212 TCS communication
from “ABS actuator and electric unit (con- shorted.) F
1212 line
trol unit)” continuously. ● ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
● Dead (Weak) battery
G
DTC Confirmation Procedure ABS00CAO
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V at idle. H
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
I
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 10 seconds.
4. If a 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1141, "Diagnostic Proce- J
dure" .
L
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above. M
Description ABS00CAQ
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
Cooling Fan Control
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Engine speed*1
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant
pressure, and air conditioner ON signal. The control system has 2-step control [HIGH/OFF].
Cooling Fan Operation
PBIB1550E
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will F
rise.
When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction is
indicated. G
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors H
(The cooling fan circuit is open or
● Cooling fan does not operate properly (Over- shorted.)
heat). ● Cooling fan I
● Cooling fan system does not operate prop- ● Radiator hose
P1217 Engine over tempera- erly (Overheat).
● Radiator
1217 ture (Overheat) ● Engine coolant was not added to the system
● Radiator cap J
using the proper filling method.
● Water pump
● Engine coolant is not within the specified
range. ● Thermostat
For more information, refer to EC-1150, K
"Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
CAUTION: L
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to CO-36, "Changing Engine
Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil. Refer to LU-26, "Changing Engine Oil" .
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-13, "Anti-Freeze Coolant Mixture Ratio" . M
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check ABS00CAT
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
SEF621W
SEF646X
WITH GST
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-1147,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-1147,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connec-
tor.
4. Connect 150Ω resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor SEF621W
harness connector.
5. Start engine and make sure that cooling fan operates at higher
speed than low speed.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
6. If NG, go to EC-1147, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF882V
EC
TBWM0254E
TBWM0255E
1. INSPECTION START A
SEF646X
H
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OPERATION
Without CONSULT-II I
1. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
2. Connect 150Ω resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
3. Start engine and let it idle. J
4. Make sure that cooling fan operate.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4. K
NG >> Check cooling fan control circuit. (Go to EC-1149,
"PROCEDURE A" .)
L
M
SEF882V
● Hose
● Radiator
● Water pump
SLC755A
6. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
2. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
Valve opening 82°C (180°F) [standard]
temperature:
Valve lift: More than 10.0 mm/95°C
(0.394 in/203°F)
3. Check if valve is closed at 5°C (9°F) below valve opening tem-
perature.
For details, refer to CO-51, "THERMOSTAT AND WATER CON-
TROL VALVE" .
SLC343
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace thermostat
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT C
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3. F
NG >> GO TO 2.
G
PBIB0966E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. J
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Disconnect IPDM E/R harness connector E5. K
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan motor terminal 1
and IPDM E/R terminal 11, cooling fan motor terminal 2 and L
IPDM E/R terminal 8.
Refer to wiring diagram.
Continuity should exist. M
ON*2 6 ● Thermostat ● Touch the upper and Both hoses should be hot CO-51
lower radiator hoses
Terminals F
Speed
(+) (−)
Cooling fan motor High 1, 2 3, 4
G
Cooling fan motor should operate.
If NG, replace cooling fan motor.
SEF321T
H
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1153, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
E
PBIB1494E
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for 32 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1155, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
E
PBIB1494E
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1158, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0420E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB0914E
Description ABS00CBC
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Engine speed *1
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
SEF337U
A
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
● EVAP canister purge volume control EC
solenoid valve
The canister purge flow is detected during the (The valve is stuck open.)
EVAP canister purge
P1444 specified driving conditions, even when EVAP
volume control solenoid ● EVAP canister vent control valve C
1444 canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
valve ● EVAP canister
completely closed.
● Hoses
(Hoses are connected incorrectly or D
clogged.)
L
PBIB0839E
6. Start engine and let it idle until “TESTING” on CONSULT-II changes to “COMPLETED”. (It will take
approximately 10 seconds.) M
If “TESTING” is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2.
7. Make sure that “OK” is displayed after touching “SELF-DIAG RESULTS”. If “NG” is displayed, refer to EC-
1164, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 20 seconds.
4. Select MODE 7 with GST.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1164, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
TBWM0246E
[Engine is running]
● Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More G
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
PBIB0051E H
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch: OFF]
0 - 1.5V
● For a few seconds after turning ignition I
ECM relay switch OFF
111 W/B
(Self shut-off)
[Ignition switch: OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
● More than a few seconds after turning igni- J
(11 - 14V)
tion switch OFF
119 R BATTERY VOLTAGE
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch: ON]
120 R (11 - 14V) K
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
1. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB1478E
PBIB0148E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 45 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
K
PBIB0147E
PBIB1031E
PBIB0149E
E
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions. F
Air passage continuity
Condition
between A and B
12V direct current supply between G
Yes
terminals 1 and 2
No supply No
H
PBIB0150E
The EVAP canister vent control valve is located on the EVAP canis-
ter and is used to seal the canister vent.
This solenoid valve responds to signals from the ECM. When the
ECM sends an ON signal, the coil in the solenoid valve is energized.
A plunger will then move to seal the canister vent. The ability to seal
the vent is necessary for the on board diagnosis of other evaporative
emission control system components.
This solenoid valve is used only for diagnosis, and usually remains
opened.
When the vent is closed, under normal purge conditions, the evapo-
rative emission control system is depressurized and allows EVAP
PBIB1263E
Control System diagnosis.
PBIB1522E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● EVAP canister vent control valve
● EVAP control system pressure sensor
P1446 EVAP canister vent con- EVAP canister vent control valve remains and the circuit
1446 trol valve close closed under specified driving conditions. ● Blocked rubber tube to EVAP canister
vent control valve
● EVAP canister is saturated with water
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds. C
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select “DATA MONITOR” mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and let it idle for at least 1 minute. D
5. Repeat next procedures 3 times.
a. Increase the engine speed up to 3,000 to 3,500 rpm and keep it
for 2 minutes and 50 seconds to 3 minutes. E
Never exceed 3 minutes.
b. Fully released accelerator pedal and keep engine idle for about
5 seconds. F
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1171, "Diagnostic Proce- SEF058Y
dure" .
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to the next step.
G
7. Repeat next procedure 20 times.
a. Quickly increase the engine speed up to 4,000 to 4,500 rpm or more and keep it for 25 to 30 seconds.
b. Fully released accelerator pedal and keep engine idle for at least 35 seconds. H
K
PBIB0972E
TBWH0110E
H
PBIB1522E
PBIB1031E
PBIB1033E
D
7. Clean the air passage (Portion A to B ) of EVAP canister vent control valve using an air blower.
8. Perform step 6 again.
Without CONSULT-II E
1. Remove EVAP canister vent control valve from EVAP canister.
2. Check portion B of EVAP canister vent control valve for being
rusted. F
PBIB1033E
I
3. Check air passage continuity and operation delay time under the
following conditions.
Make sure that new O-ring is installed properly.
J
Condition Air passage continuity between A and B
12V direct current supply between
No
terminals 1 and 2 K
OFF Yes
Operation takes less than 1 second.
L
If NG, replace EVAP canister vent control valve. PBIB1034E
PBIB1540E
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TBWM0273E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
ACCEL/RESUME Pressed ON
RESUME/ACC SW
switch Released OFF MBIB0064E
Pressed ON
COAST/SET switch SET SW
Released OFF
Pressed ON
DISTANCE switch DIST SW
Released OFF
Pressed ON
CANCEL switch CANCEL SW
Released OFF
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 99 and ground with press-
ing each button.
Switch Condition Voltage [V]
Pressed Approx. 0
ON/OFF (MAIN) switch
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 3.7
ACCEL/RESUME switch
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 3.0
COAST/SET switch PBIB0311E
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 2.2
DISTANCE switch
Released Approx. 4.3
Pressed Approx. 1.3
CANCEL switch
Released Approx. 4.3
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 3.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
H
5. CHECK ICC STEERING SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 99 and combination switch terminal 14.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. I
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1513E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CBZ
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Press ON/OFF (MAIN) switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Press ACCEL/RESUME switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Press COAST/SET switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
7. Press CANCEL switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
8. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1184, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0257E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
ACCEL/RESUME Pressed ON
RESUME/ACC SW
switch Released OFF
E
Pressed ON
COAST/SET switch SET SW
Released OFF
SEC006D
Pressed ON F
CANCEL switch CANCEL SW
Released OFF
Without CONSULT-II G
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 99 and ground with press- H
ing each button.
Switch Condition Voltage [V]
Pressed Approx. 0 I
ON/OFF (MAIN) switch
Released Approx. 4
Pressed Approx. 3
ACCEL/RESUME switch J
Released Approx. 4
Pressed Approx. 2
COAST/SET switch PBIB0311E
Released Approx. 4 K
Pressed Approx. 1
CANCEL switch
Released Approx. 4
L
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 3.
M
3. CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect combination switch harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between combination switch terminal
15 and ECM terminal 82. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
PBIB1513E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ASCD STEERING SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 99 and combination switch terminal 14.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Step 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road test
is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Press ON/OFF switch on ICC steering switch.
4. Drive the vehicle at more than 40 km/h (25 MPH).
5. Press COAST/SET switch.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1188, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00CC7
When the brake pedal is depressed, ICC brake switch is turned OFF
and stop lamp switch is turned ON. ECM detects the state of the EC
brake pedal by this input of two kinds (ON/OFF signal).
Refer to ACS-6, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
C
PBIB1539E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CC9
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● Procedure for malfunction B is not described here. It takes extremely long time to complete procedure for
malfunction B. By performing procedure for malfunction A, the incident that causes malfunction B can be
detected.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 3 and 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine (VDC switch OFF).
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Press MAIN switch and make sure that CRUISE indicator lights
up.
4. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the
following conditions.
VHCL SPEED SE More than 30 km/h (19 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
EC
TBWM0274E
SEC011D
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
MBIB0061E
SEC013D
E
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions. F
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is fully released Approximately 0V
G
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Battery voltage
PBIB1537E
I
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> GO TO 12. J
PBIB1531E
PBIB1538E
PBIB1539E
PBIB0857E
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
D
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and ICC brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. E
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power. F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
8. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH
Refer to EC-1197, "Component Inspection" . H
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ICC brake switch. I
9. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
J
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 4 and ECM terminal 108. K
Refer Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
L
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
M
NG >> GO TO 10.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ICC brake hold relay.
PBIB1539E
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
14. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 15.
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
G
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection ABS00CCE
PBIB1536E
L
PBIB1535E
PBIB1506E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CCG
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
● If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait
at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
● Procedure for malfunction B is not described here. It takes extremely long time to complete procedure for
malfunction B. By performing procedure for malfunction A, the incident that causes malfunction B can be
detected.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 3 and 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine (VDC switch OFF).
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Press MAIN switch and make sure that CRUISE indicator lights
up.
4. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the
following conditions.
VHCL SPEED SE More than 30 km/h (19 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
EC
TBWM0258E
SEC011D
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
MBIB0061E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
SEC013D E
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the following conditions. F
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is fully released Approximately 0V
G
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Battery voltage
I
PBIB1537E
OK or NG J
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 8.
K
PBIB1506E
PBIB0857E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ASCD BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 108 and ASCD brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1506E
G
PBIB1184E
K
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
● Fuse block (J/B) connector E201 L
● 10A fuse
● Joint connector-2
M
● Harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1536E
PBIB1535E
The ECM receives two vehicle speed signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from “unified meter and
A/C amp.”, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). The ECM uses these signals for ICC EC
control. Refer to ACS-6, "DESCRIPTION" for ICC functions.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00CCN
C
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
The MIL will not light up for this diagnosis.
NOTE:
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC D
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0500, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0500.
Refer to EC-1046, "DTC P0500 VSS" . E
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
F
● Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
● TCM G
P1574 ICC vehicle speed ECM detects a difference between two vehicle
1574 sensor speed signals is out of the specified range. ● ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
● Wheel sensor
H
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
● ECM
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
2. CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”
Refer to BRC-12, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
The ECM receives two vehicle speed sensor signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from “unified
meter and A/C amp.”, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). The ECM uses these signals EC
for ASCD control. Refer to EC-1334, "AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)" for ASCD func-
tions.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00CCR C
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
The MIL will not light up for this diagnosis.
NOTE: D
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0500, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0500. E
Refer to EC-1046, "DTC P0500 VSS"
● If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605.
Refer to EC-1057, "DTC P0605 ECM" F
Trouble diagnosis
DTC No. DTC detecting condition Possible cause
name
● Harness or connectors
G
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
● Unified meter and A/C amp. H
P1574 ASCD vehicle speed ECM detects a difference between two vehicle
1574 sensor speed signals is out of the specified range. ● ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
● Wheel sensor
● TCM I
● ECM
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
2. CHECK DTC WITH “ABS ACTUATOR AND ELECTRIC UNIT (CONTROL UNIT)”
Refer to BRC-12, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
● Harness or connectors
[The park/neutral position (PNP) switch
The signal of the park/neutral position (PNP) circuit is open or shorted.]
F
P1706 Park/neutral position
switch is not changed in the process of engine ● Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
1706 switch
starting and driving.
● Unified meter and A/C amp.
G
● TCM
H
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at I
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
J
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “P/N POSI SW” in “DATA MONITOR” mode with CON-
SULT-II. Then check the “P/N POSI SW” signal under the follow-
K
ing conditions.
Position (Selector lever) Known-good signal
N or P position ON L
Except above position OFF
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the park/neutral position (PNP) switch circuit. During this
check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 102 (PNP switch signal)
and ground under the following conditions.
Condition (Gear position) Voltage V (Known good data)
P or N position Approx. 0
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Except above position
(11 - 14V)
3. If NG, go to EC-1214, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0043E
EC
TBWM0521E
3. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect A/T assembly harness connector.
3. Disconnect “unified meter and A/C amp.” harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between A/T assembly terminal 9 and “unified meter and A/C amp.” terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-III
1. Check harness continuity between A/T assembly terminal 9 and TCM terminal 8. E
Refer to AT-108, "DTC P0615 START SIGNAL CIRCUIT" .
Continuity should exist.
F
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7. G
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Description ABS00CD1
NOTE:
If DTC P1720 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
ECM receives two vehicle speed sensor signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from “unified meter
and A/C amp.”, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). ECM uses these two signals for
engine control.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CD2
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. Drive vehicle at a speed of 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more for at least 5 seconds without brake pedal depress-
ing.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1217, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Description ABS00CD6
NOTE:
If DTC P1780 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
ECM receives current gear position signal, next gear position signal, shift change signal, shift pattern signal
through CAN communication line from TCM (Transmission control module). ECM uses these four signals for
engine control.
On Board Diagnosis Logic ABS00CD7
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Perform DTC confirmation procedure for DTC P1754, refer to AT-154, "DTC Confirmation Procedure" .
2. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1218, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
Diagnostic Procedure ABS00CD9
Description ABS00CDA
Brake switch signal is applied to the ECM through the stop lamp switch when the brake pedal is depressed.
This signal is used mainly to decrease the engine speed when the vehicle is driving.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CDB
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to a small range.
Therefore, acceleration will be poor.
Vehicle condition Driving condition
When engine is idling Normal
When accelerating Poor acceleration
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the DTC with CONSULT-II.
4. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1222, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0260E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
PBIB1506E
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT D
PBIB1089E
PBIB1185E
3. If NG, adjust stop lamp switch installation, refer to BR-6, "BRAKE PEDAL" , and perform step 2 again.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1228, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0239E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1548E
PBIB0914E H
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-3, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" . C
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1235, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0508E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1548E
PBIB0915E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
10. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 98 and APP sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram. M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-3, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
FAIL-SAFE MODE L
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
M
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1242, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
EC
TBWM0427E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
D
PBIB1480E
PBIB0082E H
7. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between electric throttle control actuator terminal 5 and ECM terminal 66.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 50 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4, ECM
terminal 69 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next PBIB1530E
F
step.
7. Perform EC-698, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-698, "Idle Air Volume Learning" . G
Removal and Installation ABS00CE4
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MIL lights up.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION: EC
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON. C
2. Select “DATA MONITOR” mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
D
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1249, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
WITH GST G
Follow the procedure “WITH CONSULT-II” above.
TBWM0509E
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1548E
PBIB0914E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0915E
Check harness for short to power and short to ground, between the following terminals.
H
ECM terminal Sensor terminal Reference Wiring Diagram
91 APP sensor terminal 4 EC-1248
47 Electric throttle control actuator terminal 1 EC-850 I
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. J
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
12. CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 5, ECM terminal 98 and
APP sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
C
>> INSPECTION END
Description ABS00CED
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Battery Battery voltage* VIAS control VIAS control solenoid valve
PBIB1876E
When the engine is running at low or medium speed, the power valve is fully closed. Under this condition, the
effective suction port length is equivalent to the total length of the intake manifold collector's suction port
including the intake valve. This long suction port provides increased air intake which results in improved suc-
tion efficiency and higher torque generation.
The surge tank and one-way valve are provided. When engine is running at high speed, the ECM sends the
signal to the VIAS control solenoid valve. This signal introduces the intake manifold vacuum into the power
valve actuator and therefore opens the power valve to two suction passages together in the collector.
Under this condition, the effective port length is equivalent to the length of the suction port provided indepen-
dently for each cylinder. This shortened port length results in enhanced engine output with reduced suction
resistance under high speeds.
The power valve is always open regardless of the engine speed when gear position is in N or P.
D
PBIB1498E
H
PBIB1498E
TBWM0270E
PBIB0171E
K
Without CONSULT-II
1. Lift up the vehicle.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature. L
3. Make sure that power valve actuator rod moves when changing
the gear position to N and D alternately.
M
PBIB0172E
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
NG (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
PBIB0174E
PBIB0175E
Condition Vacuum
12V direct current supply Should exist.
No supply Should not exist.
OK or NG
OK >> Repair or replace power valve actuator.
NG >> GO TO 4.
SEF109L
E
5. CHECK VACUUM TANK
Refer to EC-1260, "Component Inspection" .
F
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace vacuum tank. G
6. CHECK VIAS CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF. H
2. Disconnect VIAS control solenoid valve harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
I
K
PBIB1498E
PBIB0173E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK VIAS CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 29 and VIAS control solenoid valve terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0177E
VACUUM TANK
1. Disconnect vacuum hose connected to vacuum tank. E
2. Connect a vacuum pump to the port A of vacuum tank.
3. Apply vacuum and make sure that vacuum exists at the port B.
F
PBIB0846E
PBIB1516E
EC
TBWM0261E
EC
TBWM0262E
0 - 0.2V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
46 L Ignition signal No. 7 idle
PBIB0044E
60 SB Ignition signal No. 5
61 L Ignition signal No. 3
0.1 - 0.4V
62 Y Ignition signal No. 1
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB0045E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
EC
TBWM0263E
0 - 0.2V
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Idle speed
NOTE:
The pulse cycle changes depending on rpm at
65 Y Ignition signal No. 8 idle
PBIB0044E
79 LG Ignition signal No. 6
80 GY Ignition signal No. 4
0.1 - 0.4V
81 G Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
● Warm-up condition
● Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
PBIB0045E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB0133E
E
PBIB1549E
PBIB0044E
OK or NG F
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 10.
G
4. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON. H
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
Voltage: Battery voltage I
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Go to EC-785, "POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIR- J
CUIT" .
K
MBIB0034E
PBIB1532E
PBIB0624E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK CONDENSER
Refer to EC-1272, "Component Inspection" . E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace condenser. F
K
PBIB1516E
PBIB0138E
13. CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 46, 60, 61, 62, 65, 79, 80, 81 and ignition coil terminal
1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0847E
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
EC
PBIB0794E
D
Removal and Installation ABS00CEN
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
supplies a ground to the injector circuit, the coil in the injector is
energized. The energized coil pulls the ball valve back and allows
fuel to flow through the injector into the intake manifold. The amount
of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse
duration is the length of time the injector remains open. The ECM
controls the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
SEF375Z
EC
TBWM0264E
PBIB0043E
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
1. INSPECTION START
Turn ignition switch to START.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
E
PBIB0133E
Without CONSULT-II F
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard. G
PBIB1986E
J
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
K
PBIB1518E
PBIB0582E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
C
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK INJECTOR
D
Refer to EC-1279, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. E
NG >> Replace injector.
G
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection ABS00CES
INJECTOR H
1. Disconnect injector harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals as shown in the figure.
Resistance: 13.5 - 17.5Ω [at 10 - 60°C (50 - 140°F)] I
PBIB1727E
L
Removal and Installation ABS00CET
INJECTOR
Refer to EM-188, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
M
Description ABS00CEU
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed*
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
Battery Battery voltage*
*: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM activates the fuel pump for several seconds after the ignition switch is turned ON to improve engine
startability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the camshaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows
that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the engine speed signal is not received when
the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump operation and prevents battery discharging,
thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump
relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.
Condition Fuel pump operation
Ignition switch is turned to ON Operates for 1 second.
Engine running and cranking Operates.
When engine is stopped Stops in 1.5 seconds.
Except as shown above Stops.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
A turbine type design fuel pump is used in the fuel tank.
PBIB1508E
EC
TBWH0112E
PBIB1491E
PBIB1187E
E
PBIB1926E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. H
PBIB1533E M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
FUEL PUMP
1. Disconnect “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump” harness connector.
2. Check resistance between “fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump”
terminals 1 and 3.
Resistance: Approximately 0.2 - 5.0Ω [at 25°C (77°F)]
SEC918C
PBIB0794E
FUEL PUMP
Refer to FL-4, "FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY" .
PBIB1492E
H
PBIB2657E
TBWM0265E
PBIB1188E
L
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
PBIB1492E
PBIB0188E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors. G
7. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 70 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 2. H
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
I
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9. J
NG >> GO TO 8.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
M
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-784, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace refrigerant pressure sensor.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation ABS00CF3
Description ABS00CF4
The electrical load signal (Headlamp switch signal, rear window defogger switch signal, etc.) is transferred
through the CAN communication line from BCM to ECM via IPDM E/R.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CF5
PBIB0103E
When depress on the brake pedal, ICC brake switch is turned OFF
and stop lamp switch is turned ON. ECM detects the state of the EC
brake pedal by this input of two kinds (ON/OFF signal)
Refer to ACS-6, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
C
PBIB1539E
E
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CF8
TBWM0275E
SEC011D
K
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
L
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE M
When brake pedal is slightly depress Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
MBIB0061E
SEC013D
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is fully released Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Battery voltage
PBIB1537E
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 12.
PBIB1531E
E
4. Check voltage between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9. G
NG >> GO TO 5.
H
PBIB1538E
PBIB1539E M
PBIB0857E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and ICC brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 4 and ECM terminal 108.
Refer Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ICC brake fold relay.
PBIB1539E
E
3. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT -II or tester.
F
Voltage: Battery voltage
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14. G
NG >> GO TO 13.
H
PBIB1184E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
L
14. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector. M
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 15.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
E
PBIB1536E
PBIB1535E
J
ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ICC brake hold relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 4, 6 and 7 under
the following conditions. K
PBIB1506E
EC
TBWM0266E
SEC011D
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
MBIB0061E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
SEC013D E
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the following conditions. F
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is fully released Approximately 0V
G
When brake pedal is slightly depressed Battery voltage
I
PBIB1537E
OK or NG J
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 8.
K
PBIB1506E
PBIB0857E
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ASCD BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 108 and ASCD brake switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
4. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1506E
G
PBIB1184E
K
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
● Fuse block (J/B) connector E201 L
● 10A fuse
● Joint connector-2
M
● Harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB1536E
PBIB1535E
ASCD indicator lamp illuminates to indicate ASCD operation status. Lamp has two indicators, CRUISE and
SET, and is integrated in combination meter. EC
CRUISE indicator illuminates when ON/OFF (MAIN) switch on ASCD steering switch is turned ON to indicated
that ASCD system is ready for operation.
SET indicator illuminates when following conditions are met.
C
● CRUISE indicator is illuminated.
● COAST/SET switch on ASCD steering switch is turned ON while vehicle speed is within the range of
ASCD setting.
D
SET indicator remains lit during ASCD control.
Refer to EC-1334, "AUTOMATIC SPEED CONTROL DEVICE (ASCD)" for the ASCD function.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode ABS00CFI E
Specification data are reference value.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
F
● ON/OFF (MAIN) switch:
CRUISE LAMP ● Ignition switch: ON Pressed at the 1st time → at the ON → OFF
2nd time
G
● ON/OFF (MAIN) switch: ON ● ASCD is operating ON
TBWM0267E
OK or NG
E
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK DTC F
Description ABS00CFL
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 are displayed, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000, U1001.
Refer to EC-792, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The snow mode switch signal is sent to the “unified meter and A/C amp.” from the snow mode switch. The
“unified meter and A/C amp.” then sends the signal to the ECM by CAN communication line.
The snow mode is used for driving or starting the vehicle on snowy roads or slippery areas. If the snow mode
is activated, the vehicle speed will not be accelerated immediately than your original pedal in due to avoid the
vehicle slip. In other words, ECM controls the rapid engine torque change by controlling the electric throttle
control actuator operating speed.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in the Data Monitor Mode ABS00CFM
EC
TBWH0217E
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB2195E
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace ground connections.
CONDITION VOLTAGE
Snow mode switch: ON Battery voltage D
Snow mode switch: OFF 0V
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8. E
NG >> GO TO 5. PBIB2010E
PBIB2011E
K
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
L
● 10A fuse
● Harness for open or short between snow mode switch and fuse.
M
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK SNOW MODE SWITCH OUT PUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between snow mode switch terminal 3 and “unified meter and A/C amp.” termi-
nal 12. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK SNOW MODE INDICATOR LAMP GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between snow mode switch terminal 6 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
Continuity should exist.
2. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB2082E
Condition Continuity
1 Should exist.
2 Should not exist.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace snow mode switch.
H
PBIB2012E
TBWM0268E
EC
TBWM0269E
Description ABS00CFR
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
PBIB1631E
The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel
system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank.
The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
proportionally regulated as the air flow increases.
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
idling.
EC
PBIB1524E
PBIB1523E
EVAP CANISTER A
Check EVAP canister as follows:
1. Block port B .
EC
2. Blow air into port A and check that it flows freely out of port C .
3. Release blocked port B .
4. Apply vacuum pressure to port B and check that vacuum pres-
C
sure exists at the ports A and C .
5. Block port A and B .
6. Apply pressure to port C and check that there is no leakage. D
PBIB1044E
FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FULLER CAP) E
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
H
SEF445Y
SEF462UA
EVAP CANISTER
Tighten EVAP canister as shown in the figure.
PBIB1628E
PBIB1030E
CAUTION:
● Do not use compressed air or a high pressure pump.
● Do not exceed 4.12 kPa (0.042 kg/cm2 , 0.6 psi) of pressure in EVAP system.
NOTE:
● Do not start engine.
● Improper installation of EVAP service port adapter to the EVAP service port may cause a leak.
E
PEF838U
PEF917U
I
SEF200U
WITHOUT CONSULT-II M
1. Attach the EVAP service port adapter securely to the EVAP ser-
vice port.
2. Also attach the pressure pump with pressure gauge to the EVAP
service port adapter.
SEF462UA
PBIB1522E
4. To locate the leak, deliver positive pressure to the EVAP system until pressure gauge points reach 1.38 to
2.76 kPa (0.014 to 0.028 kg/cm2 , 0.2 to 0.4 psi).
5. Remove EVAP service port adapter and hose with pressure pump.
6. Locate the leak using a leak detector. Refer to EC-1321, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
EC
PBIB1068E
G
From the beginning of refueling, the air and vapor inside the fuel tank go through refueling EVAP vapor cut
valve and EVAP/ORVR line to the EVAP canister. The vapor is absorbed by the EVAP canister and the air is
released to the atmosphere. H
When the refueling has reached the full level of the fuel tank, the refueling EVAP vapor cut valve is closed and
refueling is stopped because of auto shut-off. The vapor which was absorbed by the EVAP canister is purged
during driving.
I
WARNING:
When conducting inspections below, be sure to observe the following:
● Put a “CAUTION: INFLAMMABLE” sign in workshop.
J
● Do not smoke while servicing fuel system. Keep open flames and sparks away from work area.
● Be sure to furnish the workshop with a CO2 fire extinguisher.
CAUTION: K
● Before removing fuel line parts, carry out the following procedures:
– Put drained fuel in an explosion-proof container and put lid on securely.
– Release fuel pressure from fuel line. Refer to EC-700, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" . L
– Disconnect battery ground cable.
● Always replace O-ring when the fuel gauge retainer is removed.
● Do not kink or twist hose and tube when they are installed. M
● Do not tighten hose and clamps excessively to avoid damaging hoses.
● After installation, run engine and check for fuel leaks at connection.
● Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off automatically.
Continued refueling may cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel spray and possibly a fire.
PBIB1031E
>> GO TO 4.
H
PBIB1031E
L
>> Repair or replace EVAP hose.
SEF665U
EC
PBIB1035E
G
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel tank. Refer to FL-10, "FUEL TANK" .
2. Drain fuel from the tank as follows: H
a. Remove fuel gauge retainer.
b. Drain fuel from the tank using a handy pump into a fuel container.
I
3. Check refueling EVAP vapor cut valve for being stuck to close as follows.
Blow air into the refueling EVAP vapor cut valve (from the end of EVAP/ORVR line hose), and check that
the air flows freely into the tank.
4. Check refueling EVAP vapor cut valve for being stuck to open as follows. J
a. Connect vacuum pump to hose end.
b. Remove fuel gauge retainer with fuel gauge unit.
Always replace O-ring with new one. K
c. Put fuel tank upside down.
d. Apply vacuum pressure to hose end [−13.3 kPa (−100 mmHg, −3.94 inHg)] with fuel gauge retainer
L
remaining open and check that the pressure is applicable.
PBIB1035E
Description ABS00CFY
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
PBIB0062E
PBIB1588E
PBIB1589E
S-ET277
D
Fuel pressure at idling kPa (kg/cm2 , psi) Approximately 350 (3.57, 51)
A
Resistance [at 10 - 60°C (50 - 140°F)] 13.5 - 17.5Ω
EC
Resistance [at 25°C (77°F)] Approximately 0.2 - 5.0Ω